* ld/pe-dll.c (autofilter_symbollist): Add cygwin_crt0.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
1e698235 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
87885426
FN
34@set DATE June 2002
35
36@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
37@set EDITOR /bin/ex
c906108c 38
6c0e9fb3 39@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 40
c906108c 41@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 42@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
43@dircategory Programming & development tools.
44@direntry
c906108c 45* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
46@end direntry
47
c906108c
SS
48@ifinfo
49This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
50
51
5d161b24 52This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
53of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
54for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
55
8a037dd7 56Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
1e698235 57 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 58
e9c75b65
EZ
59Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
60under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
61any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
62Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
63Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
64and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 65
6826cf00
EZ
66(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
67freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
68published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
69development.''
c906108c
SS
70@end ifinfo
71
72@titlepage
73@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
74@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 75@sp 1
c906108c
SS
76@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
77@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 78@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 79@page
c906108c
SS
80@tex
81{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 82\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
83\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
84\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
85}
86@end tex
53a5351d 87
c906108c 88@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7 89Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
1e698235 901996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 91@sp 2
c906108c
SS
92Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9359 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
94Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 95ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
96
97Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
98under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
99any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
100Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
101Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
102and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 103
6826cf00
EZ
104(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
105freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
106published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
107development.''
c906108c
SS
108@end titlepage
109@page
110
6c0e9fb3 111@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
112@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
113
c906108c
SS
114@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
115
116This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
117
5d161b24 118This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
119@value{GDBVN}.
120
1e698235 121Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
122
123@menu
124* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
125* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
126
127* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
128* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
129* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
130* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
131* Stack:: Examining the stack
132* Source:: Examining source files
133* Data:: Examining data
e2e0bcd1 134* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
b37052ae 135* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 136* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
137
138* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
139
140* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
141* Altering:: Altering execution
142* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
143* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 144* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 148* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
149* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 151* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
152
153* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 159* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 160* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
aab4e0ec
AC
161* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
162 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 163* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
164* Index:: Index
165@end menu
166
6c0e9fb3 167@end ifnottex
c906108c 168
449f3b6c 169@contents
449f3b6c 170
6d2ebf8b 171@node Summary
c906108c
SS
172@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
173
174The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
175going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
176program was doing at the moment it crashed.
177
178@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
179these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
180
181@itemize @bullet
182@item
183Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
184
185@item
186Make your program stop on specified conditions.
187
188@item
189Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
190
191@item
192Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
193effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
194@end itemize
195
cce74817 196You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 197For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
198For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
199
cce74817 200@cindex Modula-2
e632838e
AC
201Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
202@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
c906108c 203
cce74817
JM
204@cindex Pascal
205Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
206nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
207entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
208syntax.
c906108c 209
c906108c
SS
210@cindex Fortran
211@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 212it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 213underscore.
c906108c 214
c906108c
SS
215@menu
216* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
217* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
218@end menu
219
6d2ebf8b 220@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
221@unnumberedsec Free software
222
5d161b24 223@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
224General Public License
225(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
226program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
227freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
228the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
229Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
230Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
231
232Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
233you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
234from anyone else.
235
2666264b 236@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
237
238The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
239the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
240include with the free software. Many of our most important
241programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
242texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
243when an important free software package does not come with a free
244manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
245gaps today.
246
247Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
248normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
249authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
250copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
251them from the free software world.
252
253That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
254from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
255manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
256only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
257contract to make it non-free.
258
259Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
260price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
261charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
262Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
263problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
264are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
265modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
266
267The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
268free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
269commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
270accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
271
272Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
273When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
274are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
275provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
276manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
277a changed version of the program is not really available to our
278community.
279
280Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
281acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
282author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
283authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
284to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
285may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
286with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
287are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
288of the manual.
289
290However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
291content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
292media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
293obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
294manual to replace it.
295
296Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
297lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
298free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
299the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
300realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
301the free software community.
302
303If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
304the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
305license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
306don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
307will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
308option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
309what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
310try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 311is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
312
313You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
314manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
315copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
316improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
317at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
318and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
319Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
320have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
321
322The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
323published by other publishers, at
324@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
325
6d2ebf8b 326@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
327@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
328
329Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
330other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
331development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
332of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
333to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
334file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
335blow-by-blow account.
336
337Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
338
339@quotation
340@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
341or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
342omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
343@end quotation
344
345So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
346particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
347releases:
299ffc64 348Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
c906108c
SS
349Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
350Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
351Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
352Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
353Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
354John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
355Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
356and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
357
358Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
359Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
360
b37052ae
EZ
361Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
362in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
363Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
364demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
365much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 366
b37052ae 367@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
368object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
369Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
370
371David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
372the original support for encapsulated COFF.
373
96c405b3 374Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
375
376Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
377Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
378support.
379Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
380Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
381Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
382David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
383Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
384Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
385Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
386Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
387Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
388Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
389Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
390Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
391Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
392Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
393Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
a37295f9 394Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
c906108c 395
1104b9e7 396Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
c906108c
SS
397
398Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
399libraries.
400
401Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
402about several machine instruction sets.
403
404Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
405remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
406contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
407and RDI targets, respectively.
408
409Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
410command-line editing and command history.
411
7a292a7a
SS
412Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
413Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 414
5d161b24 415Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 416He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 417symbols.
c906108c
SS
418
419Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
420Super-H processors.
421
422NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
423
424Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
425
426Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
427
428Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
429
96a2c332 430Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
431
432Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
433watchpoints.
434
435Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
436
437Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
438
439Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 440nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
441
442The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
443support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 444(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
445compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
446John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
447Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
448information in this manual.
449
b37052ae
EZ
450DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
451Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
452
96a2c332
SS
453Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
454development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
455fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
456Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
457Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
458Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
459Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
460addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
461JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
462Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
463Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
464Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
465Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
466Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
467Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c 468
e2e0bcd1
JB
469Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
470Hat.
c906108c 471
6d2ebf8b 472@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
473@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
474
475You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
476However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
477debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
478
479@iftex
480In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
481to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
482@end iftex
483
484@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
485@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
486
487One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
488processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
489quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
490definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
491session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
492then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
493same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
494@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
495procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
496
497@smallexample
498$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
499$ @b{./m4}
500@b{define(foo,0000)}
501
502@b{foo}
5030000
504@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
505
506@b{bar}
5070000
508@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
509
510@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
511@b{baz}
512@b{C-d}
513m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
514@end smallexample
515
516@noindent
517Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
518
c906108c
SS
519@smallexample
520$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
521@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
522@c FIXME... format to come out better.
523@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 524 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 525 the conditions.
5d161b24 526There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
527 for details.
528
529@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
530(@value{GDBP})
531@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
532
533@noindent
534@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
535rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
536We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
537that examples fit in this manual.
538
539@smallexample
540(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
541@end smallexample
542
543@noindent
544We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
545Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
546@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
547@code{break} command.
548
549@smallexample
550(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
551Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
552@end smallexample
553
554@noindent
555Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
556control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
557subroutine, the program runs as usual:
558
559@smallexample
560(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
561Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
562@b{define(foo,0000)}
563
564@b{foo}
5650000
566@end smallexample
567
568@noindent
569To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
570suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
571context where it stops.
572
573@smallexample
574@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
575
5d161b24 576Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
577 at builtin.c:879
578879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
579@end smallexample
580
581@noindent
582Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
583the next line of the current function.
584
585@smallexample
586(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
587882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
588 : nil,
589@end smallexample
590
591@noindent
592@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
593by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
594@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
595subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
596
597@smallexample
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
599set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
600 at input.c:530
601530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
602@end smallexample
603
604@noindent
605The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
606suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
607shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
608command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
609in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
610stack frame for each active subroutine.
611
612@smallexample
613(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
614#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
615 at input.c:530
5d161b24 616#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
617 at builtin.c:882
618#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
619#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
620 at macro.c:71
621#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
622#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
623@end smallexample
624
625@noindent
626We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
627times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
628falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
629
630@smallexample
631(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6320x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
633(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6340x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
635def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
636(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
637536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
638 : xstrdup(rq);
639(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
640538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
641@end smallexample
642
643@noindent
644The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
645@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
646and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
647(@code{print}) to see their values.
648
649@smallexample
650(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
651$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
652(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
653$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
654@end smallexample
655
656@noindent
657@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
658To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
659surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
660
661@smallexample
662(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
663533 xfree(rquote);
664534
665535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
666 : xstrdup (lq);
667536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
668 : xstrdup (rq);
669537
670538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
671539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
672540 @}
673541
674542 void
675@end smallexample
676
677@noindent
678Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
679@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
680
681@smallexample
682(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
683539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
684(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685540 @}
686(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
687$3 = 9
688(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
689$4 = 7
690@end smallexample
691
692@noindent
693That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
694@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
695@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
696the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
697any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
698assignments.
699
700@smallexample
701(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
702$5 = 7
703(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
704$6 = 9
705@end smallexample
706
707@noindent
708Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
709@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
710executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
711example that caused trouble initially:
712
713@smallexample
714(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
715Continuing.
716
717@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
718
719baz
7200000
721@end smallexample
722
723@noindent
724Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
725problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
726lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
727
728@smallexample
729@b{C-d}
730Program exited normally.
731@end smallexample
732
733@noindent
734The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
735indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
736session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
737
738@smallexample
739(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
740@end smallexample
c906108c 741
6d2ebf8b 742@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
743@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
744
745This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 746The essentials are:
c906108c 747@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 748@item
53a5351d 749type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 750@item
c906108c
SS
751type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
752@end itemize
753
754@menu
755* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
756* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
757* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
758@end menu
759
6d2ebf8b 760@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
761@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
762
c906108c
SS
763Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
764@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
765
766You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
767to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
768
c906108c
SS
769The command-line options described here are designed
770to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 771options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
772
773The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
774specifying an executable program:
775
474c8240 776@smallexample
c906108c 777@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 778@end smallexample
c906108c 779
c906108c
SS
780@noindent
781You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
782specified:
783
474c8240 784@smallexample
c906108c 785@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 786@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
787
788You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
789to debug a running process:
790
474c8240 791@smallexample
c906108c 792@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 793@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
794
795@noindent
796would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
797named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
798
c906108c 799Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
800complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
801debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
802``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
803will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 804
aa26fa3a
TT
805You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
806executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
807option processing.
474c8240 808@smallexample
aa26fa3a 809gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 810@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
811This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
812@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
813
96a2c332 814You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
815@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
816
817@smallexample
818@value{GDBP} -silent
819@end smallexample
820
821@noindent
822You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
823options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
824
825@noindent
826Type
827
474c8240 828@smallexample
c906108c 829@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 830@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
831
832@noindent
833to display all available options and briefly describe their use
834(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
835
836All options and command line arguments you give are processed
837in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
838@samp{-x} option is used.
839
840
841@menu
c906108c
SS
842* File Options:: Choosing files
843* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
844@end menu
845
6d2ebf8b 846@node File Options
c906108c
SS
847@subsection Choosing files
848
2df3850c 849When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
850specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
851the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
852@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
853first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
854equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
855second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
856equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
857If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
858first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
859to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
860a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 861prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
862
863If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
864such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
865argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
866
867Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
868following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
869them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
870(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
871than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
872
d700128c
EZ
873@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
874@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
875@c it.
876
c906108c
SS
877@table @code
878@item -symbols @var{file}
879@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
880@cindex @code{--symbols}
881@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
882Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
883
884@item -exec @var{file}
885@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
886@cindex @code{--exec}
887@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
888Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
889and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
890
891@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 892@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
893Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
894file.
895
c906108c
SS
896@item -core @var{file}
897@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
898@cindex @code{--core}
899@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 900Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
901
902@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
903@item -pid @var{number}
904@itemx -p @var{number}
905@cindex @code{--pid}
906@cindex @code{-p}
907Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
908If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
909file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
910
911@item -command @var{file}
912@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
913@cindex @code{--command}
914@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
915Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
916Files,, Command files}.
917
918@item -directory @var{directory}
919@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
920@cindex @code{--directory}
921@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
922Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
923
c906108c
SS
924@item -m
925@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
926@cindex @code{--mapped}
927@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
928@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
929supported on all systems.}@*
930If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 931system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
932to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
933program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 934called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
935Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
936and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
937the symbol table from the executable program.
938
939The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
940is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
941table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 942
c906108c
SS
943@item -r
944@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
945@cindex @code{--readnow}
946@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
947Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
948the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
949This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 950
c906108c
SS
951@end table
952
2df3850c 953You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 954order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
955information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
956on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
957but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 958
474c8240 959@smallexample
2df3850c 960gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 961@end smallexample
c906108c 962
6d2ebf8b 963@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
964@subsection Choosing modes
965
966You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
967batch mode or quiet mode.
968
969@table @code
970@item -nx
971@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
972@cindex @code{--nx}
973@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 974Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
975@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
976options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
977files}.
c906108c
SS
978
979@item -quiet
d700128c 980@itemx -silent
c906108c 981@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
982@cindex @code{--quiet}
983@cindex @code{--silent}
984@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
985``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
986messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
987
988@item -batch
d700128c 989@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
990Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
991command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
992initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
993nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
994in the command files.
995
2df3850c
JM
996Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
997example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
998make this more useful, the message
c906108c 999
474c8240 1000@smallexample
c906108c 1001Program exited normally.
474c8240 1002@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1003
1004@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1005(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1006@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1007mode.
1008
1009@item -nowindows
1010@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1011@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1012@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1013``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1014(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1015interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1016
1017@item -windows
1018@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1019@cindex @code{--windows}
1020@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1021If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1022used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1023
1024@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1025@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1026Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1027instead of the current directory.
1028
c906108c
SS
1029@item -fullname
1030@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1031@cindex @code{--fullname}
1032@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1033@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1034subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1035number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1036displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1037recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1038the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1039and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1040@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1041frame.
c906108c 1042
d700128c
EZ
1043@item -epoch
1044@cindex @code{--epoch}
1045The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1046@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1047routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1048separate window.
1049
1050@item -annotate @var{level}
1051@cindex @code{--annotate}
1052This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1053effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1054(@pxref{Annotations}).
1055Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1056together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1057types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1058@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1059maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1060
1061@item -async
1062@cindex @code{--async}
1063Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1064@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1065special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1066commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1067run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1068MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1069suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1070control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1071(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1072operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1073yet.)
1074@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1075@c should be removed.
1076
1077When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1078uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1079@samp{-noasync} option.
1080
1081@item -noasync
1082@cindex @code{--noasync}
1083Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1084
aa26fa3a
TT
1085@item --args
1086@cindex @code{--args}
1087Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1088executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1089This option stops option processing.
1090
2df3850c
JM
1091@item -baud @var{bps}
1092@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1093@cindex @code{--baud}
1094@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1095Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1096interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1097
1098@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1099@itemx -t @var{device}
1100@cindex @code{--tty}
1101@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1102Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1103@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1104
53a5351d 1105@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1106@item -tui
1107@cindex @code{--tui}
1108Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1109The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1110showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1111(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1112Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1113(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1114
1115@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1116@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1117@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1118@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1119@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1120@c systems.
1121
d700128c
EZ
1122@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1123@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1124Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1125program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1126communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1127
da0f9dcd
AC
1128@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1129@value{GDBN} to use the current @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface}
1130(@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The previous @sc{gdb/mi}
1131interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3, can be selected with
1132@samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces
1133are not supported.
d700128c
EZ
1134
1135@item -write
1136@cindex @code{--write}
1137Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1138is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1139(@pxref{Patching}).
1140
1141@item -statistics
1142@cindex @code{--statistics}
1143This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1144memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1145
1146@item -version
1147@cindex @code{--version}
1148This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1149no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1150
c906108c
SS
1151@end table
1152
6d2ebf8b 1153@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1154@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1155@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1156@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1157
1158@table @code
1159@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1160@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1161@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1162@itemx q
1163To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1164@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1165do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1166otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1167error code.
c906108c
SS
1168@end table
1169
1170@cindex interrupt
1171An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1172terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1173returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1174character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1175until a time when it is safe.
1176
c906108c
SS
1177If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1178device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1179(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1180
6d2ebf8b 1181@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1182@section Shell commands
1183
1184If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1185debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1186just use the @code{shell} command.
1187
1188@table @code
1189@kindex shell
1190@cindex shell escape
1191@item shell @var{command string}
1192Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1193If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1194shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1195(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1196@end table
1197
1198The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1199You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1200@value{GDBN}:
1201
1202@table @code
1203@kindex make
1204@cindex calling make
1205@item make @var{make-args}
1206Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1207arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1208@end table
1209
6d2ebf8b 1210@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1211@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1212
1213You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1214name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1215@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1216key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1217show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1218
1219@menu
1220* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1221* Completion:: Command completion
1222* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1223@end menu
1224
6d2ebf8b 1225@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1226@section Command syntax
1227
1228A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1229how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1230arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1231command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1232step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1233with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1234
1235@cindex abbreviation
1236@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1237unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1238documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1239abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1240equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1241names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1242arguments to the @code{help} command.
1243
1244@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1245@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1246A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1247repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1248will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1249repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1250repeat.
1251
1252The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1253@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1254exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1255
1256@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1257output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1258(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1259@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1260repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1261
41afff9a 1262@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1263@cindex comment
1264Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1265nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1266Files,,Command files}).
1267
88118b3a
TT
1268@cindex repeating command sequences
1269@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1270The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1271commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1272then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1273for editing.
1274
6d2ebf8b 1275@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1276@section Command completion
1277
1278@cindex completion
1279@cindex word completion
1280@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1281only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1282are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1283commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1284
1285Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1286of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1287word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1288enter it). For example, if you type
1289
1290@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1291@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1292@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1293@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1294@smallexample
c906108c 1295(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1296@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1297
1298@noindent
1299@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1300the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1301
474c8240 1302@smallexample
c906108c 1303(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1304@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1305
1306@noindent
1307You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1308breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1309@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1310were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1311might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1312to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1313
1314If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1315@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1316characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1317@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1318example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1319begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1320just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1321function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1322example:
1323
474c8240 1324@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1325(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1326@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1327make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1328make_abs_section make_function_type
1329make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1330make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1331make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1332(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1333@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1334
1335@noindent
1336After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1337partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1338command.
1339
1340If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1341can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1342means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1343key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1344one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1345
1346@cindex quotes in commands
1347@cindex completion of quoted strings
1348Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1349parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1350its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1351situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1352@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1353
c906108c 1354The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1355name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1356overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1357by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1358may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1359that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1360that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1361word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1362@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1363@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1364when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1365
474c8240 1366@smallexample
96a2c332 1367(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1368bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1369(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1370@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1371
1372In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1373quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1374completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1375place:
1376
474c8240 1377@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1378(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1379@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1380(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1381@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1382
1383@noindent
1384In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1385you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1386completion on an overloaded symbol.
1387
d4f3574e 1388For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1389expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1390overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1391see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1392
1393
6d2ebf8b 1394@node Help
c906108c
SS
1395@section Getting help
1396@cindex online documentation
1397@kindex help
1398
5d161b24 1399You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1400using the command @code{help}.
1401
1402@table @code
41afff9a 1403@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1404@item help
1405@itemx h
1406You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1407display a short list of named classes of commands:
1408
1409@smallexample
1410(@value{GDBP}) help
1411List of classes of commands:
1412
2df3850c 1413aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1414breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1415data -- Examining data
c906108c 1416files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1417internals -- Maintenance commands
1418obscure -- Obscure features
1419running -- Running the program
1420stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1421status -- Status inquiries
1422support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1423tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1424 stopping the program
c906108c 1425user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1426
5d161b24 1427Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1428commands in that class.
5d161b24 1429Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1430documentation.
1431Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1432(@value{GDBP})
1433@end smallexample
96a2c332 1434@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1435
1436@item help @var{class}
1437Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1438list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1439help display for the class @code{status}:
1440
1441@smallexample
1442(@value{GDBP}) help status
1443Status inquiries.
1444
1445List of commands:
1446
1447@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1448@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1449info -- Generic command for showing things
1450 about the program being debugged
1451show -- Generic command for showing things
1452 about the debugger
c906108c 1453
5d161b24 1454Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1455documentation.
1456Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1457(@value{GDBP})
1458@end smallexample
1459
1460@item help @var{command}
1461With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1462short paragraph on how to use that command.
1463
6837a0a2
DB
1464@kindex apropos
1465@item apropos @var{args}
1466The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1467commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1468@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1469
1470@smallexample
1471apropos reload
1472@end smallexample
1473
b37052ae
EZ
1474@noindent
1475results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1476
1477@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1478@c @group
1479set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1480 multiple times in one run
1481show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1482 multiple times in one run
1483@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1484@end smallexample
1485
c906108c
SS
1486@kindex complete
1487@item complete @var{args}
1488The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1489for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1490command you want completed. For example:
1491
1492@smallexample
1493complete i
1494@end smallexample
1495
1496@noindent results in:
1497
1498@smallexample
1499@group
2df3850c
JM
1500if
1501ignore
c906108c
SS
1502info
1503inspect
c906108c
SS
1504@end group
1505@end smallexample
1506
1507@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1508@end table
1509
1510In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1511and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1512of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1513manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1514under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1515all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1516
1517@c @group
1518@table @code
1519@kindex info
41afff9a 1520@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1521@item info
1522This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1523program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1524with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1525registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1526You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1527@w{@code{help info}}.
1528
1529@kindex set
1530@item set
5d161b24 1531You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1532@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1533@code{set prompt $}.
1534
1535@kindex show
1536@item show
5d161b24 1537In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1538@value{GDBN} itself.
1539You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1540related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1541system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1542which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1543
1544@kindex info set
1545To display all the settable parameters and their current
1546values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1547@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1548@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1549@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1550@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1551@end table
1552@c @end group
1553
1554Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1555exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1556
1557@table @code
1558@kindex show version
1559@cindex version number
1560@item show version
1561Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1562information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1563@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1564version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1565commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1566system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1567variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1568The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1569@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1570
1571@kindex show copying
1572@item show copying
1573Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1574
1575@kindex show warranty
1576@item show warranty
2df3850c 1577Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1578if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1579
c906108c
SS
1580@end table
1581
6d2ebf8b 1582@node Running
c906108c
SS
1583@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1584
1585When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1586debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1587
1588You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1589of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1590your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1591kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1592
1593@menu
1594* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1595* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1596* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1597* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1598
1599* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1600* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1601* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1602* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1603
1604* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1605* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1606@end menu
1607
6d2ebf8b 1608@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1609@section Compiling for debugging
1610
1611In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1612debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1613is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1614variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1615and addresses in the executable code.
1616
1617To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1618the compiler.
1619
e2e0bcd1
JB
1620Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1621the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1622because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1623the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1624options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1625debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1626``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1627to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1628@option{-g} alone.
1629
c906108c
SS
1630Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1631options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1632executables containing debugging information.
1633
53a5351d
JM
1634@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1635without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1636recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1637program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1638in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1639
1640@cindex optimized code, debugging
1641@cindex debugging optimized code
1642When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1643optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1644really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1645exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1646variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1647variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1648
1649Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1650@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1651doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1652please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1653
1654Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1655@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1656format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1657
1658@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1659@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1660@section Starting your program
1661@cindex starting
1662@cindex running
1663
1664@table @code
1665@kindex run
41afff9a 1666@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1667@item run
1668@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1669Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1670You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1671argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1672@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1673(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1674
1675@end table
1676
c906108c
SS
1677If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1678supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1679that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1680@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1681
1682The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1683receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1684information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1685can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1686your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1687divided into four categories:
1688
1689@table @asis
1690@item The @emph{arguments.}
1691Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1692@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1693is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1694(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1695the arguments.
1696In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1697@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1698@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1699
1700@item The @emph{environment.}
1701Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1702use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1703environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1704your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1705
1706@item The @emph{working directory.}
1707Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1708the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1709@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1710
1711@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1712Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1713standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1714in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1715set a different device for your program.
1716@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1717
1718@cindex pipes
1719@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1720pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1721program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1722wrong program.
1723@end table
c906108c
SS
1724
1725When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1726immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1727of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1728stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1729or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1730
1731If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1732time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1733table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1734your current breakpoints.
1735
6d2ebf8b 1736@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1737@section Your program's arguments
1738
1739@cindex arguments (to your program)
1740The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1741@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1742They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1743performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1744@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1745@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1746the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1747
1748On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1749@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1750calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1751the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1752
1753@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1754@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1755
c906108c 1756@table @code
41afff9a 1757@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1758@item set args
1759Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1760@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1761with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1762using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1763it again without arguments.
1764
1765@kindex show args
1766@item show args
1767Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1768@end table
1769
6d2ebf8b 1770@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1771@section Your program's environment
1772
1773@cindex environment (of your program)
1774The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1775their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1776your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1777path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1778the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1779debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1780environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1781
1782@table @code
1783@kindex path
1784@item path @var{directory}
1785Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1786(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1787The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1788You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1789system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1790MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1791is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1792
1793You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1794working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1795use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1796@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1797@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1798@var{directory} to the search path.
1799@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1800@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1801
1802@kindex show paths
1803@item show paths
1804Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1805environment variable).
1806
1807@kindex show environment
1808@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1809Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1810your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1811print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1812your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1813
1814@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1815@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1816Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1817changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1818be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1819any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1820parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1821null value.
1822@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1823@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1824
1825For example, this command:
1826
474c8240 1827@smallexample
c906108c 1828set env USER = foo
474c8240 1829@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1830
1831@noindent
d4f3574e 1832tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1833@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1834are not actually required.)
1835
1836@kindex unset environment
1837@item unset environment @var{varname}
1838Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1839program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1840@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1841rather than assigning it an empty value.
1842@end table
1843
d4f3574e
SS
1844@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1845the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1846by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1847@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1848that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1849@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1850your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1851files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1852@file{.profile}.
1853
6d2ebf8b 1854@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1855@section Your program's working directory
1856
1857@cindex working directory (of your program)
1858Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1859working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1860The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1861from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1862working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1863
1864The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1865that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1866specify files}.
1867
1868@table @code
1869@kindex cd
1870@item cd @var{directory}
1871Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1872
1873@kindex pwd
1874@item pwd
1875Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1876@end table
1877
6d2ebf8b 1878@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1879@section Your program's input and output
1880
1881@cindex redirection
1882@cindex i/o
1883@cindex terminal
1884By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1885the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1886to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1887modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1888running your program.
1889
1890@table @code
1891@kindex info terminal
1892@item info terminal
1893Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1894program is using.
1895@end table
1896
1897You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1898redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1899
474c8240 1900@smallexample
c906108c 1901run > outfile
474c8240 1902@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1903
1904@noindent
1905starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1906
1907@kindex tty
1908@cindex controlling terminal
1909Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1910with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1911argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1912commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1913process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1914
474c8240 1915@smallexample
c906108c 1916tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1917@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1918
1919@noindent
1920directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1921default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1922that as their controlling terminal.
1923
1924An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1925effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1926terminal.
1927
1928When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1929command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1930for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1931
6d2ebf8b 1932@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1933@section Debugging an already-running process
1934@kindex attach
1935@cindex attach
1936
1937@table @code
1938@item attach @var{process-id}
1939This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1940outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1941targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1942find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1943or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1944
1945@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1946executing the command.
1947@end table
1948
1949To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1950which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1951programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1952also have permission to send the process a signal.
1953
1954When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1955the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1956the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1957(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1958the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1959Specify Files}.
1960
1961The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1962process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1963with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1964you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1965can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1966process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1967attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1968
1969@table @code
1970@kindex detach
1971@item detach
1972When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1973@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1974the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1975that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1976are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1977@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1978executing the command.
1979@end table
1980
1981If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1982attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1983for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1984control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1985confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1986messages}).
1987
6d2ebf8b 1988@node Kill Process
c906108c 1989@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1990
1991@table @code
1992@kindex kill
1993@item kill
1994Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1995@end table
1996
1997This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1998running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1999is running.
2000
2001On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2002while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2003@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2004outside the debugger.
2005
2006The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2007relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2008executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2009next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2010reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2011breakpoint settings).
2012
6d2ebf8b 2013@node Threads
c906108c 2014@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2015
2016@cindex threads of execution
2017@cindex multiple threads
2018@cindex switching threads
2019In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2020may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2021of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2022the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2023that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2024modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2025registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2026
2027@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2028programs:
2029
2030@itemize @bullet
2031@item automatic notification of new threads
2032@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2033@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2034@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2035a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2036@item thread-specific breakpoints
2037@end itemize
2038
c906108c
SS
2039@quotation
2040@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2041@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2042If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2043effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2044from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2045like this:
2046
2047@smallexample
2048(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2049(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2050Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2051see the IDs of currently known threads.
2052@end smallexample
2053@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2054@c doesn't support threads"?
2055@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2056
2057@cindex focus of debugging
2058@cindex current thread
2059The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2060threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2061control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2062This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2063program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2064
41afff9a 2065@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2066@cindex thread identifier (system)
2067@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2068@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2069@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2070Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2071the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2072form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2073whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2074LynxOS, you might see
2075
474c8240 2076@smallexample
c906108c 2077[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2078@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2079
2080@noindent
2081when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2082the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2083further qualifier.
2084
2085@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2086@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2087@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2088@c program?
2089@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2090@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2091@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2092
2093@cindex thread number
2094@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2095For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2096number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2097
2098@table @code
2099@kindex info threads
2100@item info threads
2101Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2102program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2103
2104@enumerate
2105@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2106
2107@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2108
2109@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2110@end enumerate
2111
2112@noindent
2113An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2114indicates the current thread.
2115
5d161b24 2116For example,
c906108c
SS
2117@end table
2118@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2119
2120@smallexample
2121(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2122 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2123 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2124* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2125 at threadtest.c:68
2126@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2127
2128On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2129
2130@cindex thread number
2131@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2132For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2133number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2134thread in your program.
2135
41afff9a
EZ
2136@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2137@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2138@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2139@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2140@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2141Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2142both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2143form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2144whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2145HP-UX, you see
2146
474c8240 2147@smallexample
c906108c 2148[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2149@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2150
2151@noindent
5d161b24 2152when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2153
2154@table @code
2155@kindex info threads
2156@item info threads
2157Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2158program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2159
2160@enumerate
2161@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2162
2163@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2164
2165@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2166@end enumerate
2167
2168@noindent
2169An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2170indicates the current thread.
2171
5d161b24 2172For example,
c906108c
SS
2173@end table
2174@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2175
474c8240 2176@smallexample
c906108c 2177(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2178 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2179 at quicksort.c:137
2180 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2181 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2182 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2183 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2184@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2185
2186@table @code
2187@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2188@item thread @var{threadno}
2189Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2190argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2191shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2192@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2193you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2194
2195@smallexample
2196@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2197(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2198[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2200@end smallexample
2201
2202@noindent
2203As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2204@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2205threads.
c906108c
SS
2206
2207@kindex thread apply
2208@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2209The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2210more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2211with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2212@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2213threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2214@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2215@end table
2216
2217@cindex automatic thread selection
2218@cindex switching threads automatically
2219@cindex threads, automatic switching
2220Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2221signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2222signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2223message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2224thread.
2225
2226@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2227more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2228programs with multiple threads.
2229
2230@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2231watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2232
6d2ebf8b 2233@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2234@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2235
2236@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2237@cindex multiple processes
2238@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2239On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2240programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2241function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2242parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2243set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2244will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2245will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2246
2247However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2248which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2249the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2250only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2251so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2252on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2253get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2254@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2255the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2256the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2257
53a5351d
JM
2258On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2259debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2260@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2261
2262By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2263the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2264
2265If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2266use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2267
2268@table @code
2269@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2270@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2271Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2272@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2273process. The @var{mode} can be:
2274
2275@table @code
2276@item parent
2277The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2278unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2279
2280@item child
2281The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2282unimpeded.
2283
2284@item ask
2285The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2286@end table
2287
2288@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2289Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2290@end table
2291
2292If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2293@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2294breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2295@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2296the child process's @code{main}.
2297
2298When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2299child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2300
2301If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2302call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2303use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2304argument.
2305
2306You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2307a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2308Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2309
6d2ebf8b 2310@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2311@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2312
2313The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2314program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2315trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2316
7a292a7a
SS
2317Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2318such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2319@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2320change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2321continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2322ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2323explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2324
2325@table @code
2326@kindex info program
2327@item info program
2328Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2329running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2330@end table
2331
2332@menu
2333* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2334* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2335* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2336* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2337@end menu
2338
6d2ebf8b 2339@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2340@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2341
2342@cindex breakpoints
2343A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2344the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2345control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2346breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2347Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2348should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2349program.
2350
2351In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2352breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2353a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2354is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2355not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2356arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2357
2358@cindex watchpoints
2359@cindex memory tracing
2360@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2361@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2362A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2363when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2364command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2365watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2366any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2367and watchpoints using the same commands.
2368
2369You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2370whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2371Automatic display}.
2372
2373@cindex catchpoints
2374@cindex breakpoint on events
2375A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2376when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2377exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2378different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2379catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2380other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2381@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2382
2383@cindex breakpoint numbers
2384@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2385@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2386catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2387starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2388features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2389breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2390@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2391enable it again.
2392
c5394b80
JM
2393@cindex breakpoint ranges
2394@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2395Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2396operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2397@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2398hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2399all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2400
c906108c
SS
2401@menu
2402* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2403* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2404* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2405* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2406* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2407* Conditions:: Break conditions
2408* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2409* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2410* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2411@end menu
2412
6d2ebf8b 2413@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2414@subsection Setting breakpoints
2415
5d161b24 2416@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2417@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2418@c
2419@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2420
2421@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2422@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2423@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2424@cindex latest breakpoint
2425Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2426@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2427number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2428Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2429convenience variables.
2430
2431You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2432
2433@table @code
2434@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2435Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2436When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2437C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2438@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2439
2440@item break +@var{offset}
2441@itemx break -@var{offset}
2442Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2443at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2444(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2445
2446@item break @var{linenum}
2447Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2448The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2449The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2450code on that line.
2451
2452@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2453Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2454
2455@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2456Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2457@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2458superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2459functions.
2460
2461@item break *@var{address}
2462Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2463breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2464information or source files.
2465
2466@item break
2467When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2468the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2469(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2470innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2471returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2472@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2473that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2474@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2475the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2476inside loops.
2477
2478@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2479least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2480would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2481breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2482existed when your program stopped.
2483
2484@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2485Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2486@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2487value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2488@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2489above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2490,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2491
2492@kindex tbreak
2493@item tbreak @var{args}
2494Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2495same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2496way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2497program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2498
c906108c
SS
2499@kindex hbreak
2500@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2501Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2502@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2503breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2504have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2505debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2506changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2507provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2508will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2509address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2510breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2511example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2512@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2513or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2514(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2515
2516@kindex thbreak
2517@item thbreak @var{args}
2518Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2519are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2520the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2521the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2522first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2523command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2524may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2525See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2526
2527@kindex rbreak
2528@cindex regular expression
2529@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2530Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2531@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2532matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2533breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2534the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2535them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2536
2537The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2538like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2539shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2540an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2541@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2542match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2543
b37052ae 2544When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2545breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2546classes.
c906108c
SS
2547
2548@kindex info breakpoints
2549@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2550@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2551@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2552@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2553Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2554not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2555
2556@table @emph
2557@item Breakpoint Numbers
2558@item Type
2559Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2560@item Disposition
2561Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2562@item Enabled or Disabled
2563Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2564that are not enabled.
2565@item Address
2df3850c 2566Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2567@item What
2568Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2569line number.
2570@end table
2571
2572@noindent
2573If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2574the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2575are listed after that.
2576
2577@noindent
2578@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2579number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2580convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2581the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2582listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2583
2584@noindent
2585@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2586has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2587@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2588hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2589was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2590will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2591@end table
2592
2593@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2594your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2595the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2596(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2597
2598@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2599@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2600@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2601special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2602programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2603starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2604You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2605@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2606
2607
6d2ebf8b 2608@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2609@subsection Setting watchpoints
2610
2611@cindex setting watchpoints
2612@cindex software watchpoints
2613@cindex hardware watchpoints
2614You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2615expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2616this may happen.
2617
2618Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2619hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2620program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2621times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2622catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2623culprit.)
2624
1104b9e7 2625On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2626@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2627hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2628program.
2629
2630@table @code
2631@kindex watch
2632@item watch @var{expr}
2633Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2634is written into by the program and its value changes.
2635
2636@kindex rwatch
2637@item rwatch @var{expr}
2638Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2639
2640@kindex awatch
2641@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2642Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2643by the program.
c906108c
SS
2644
2645@kindex info watchpoints
2646@item info watchpoints
2647This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2648it is the same as @code{info break}.
2649@end table
2650
2651@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2652watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2653value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2654cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2655executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2656statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2657
2658When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2659
474c8240 2660@smallexample
c906108c 2661Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2662@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2663
2664@noindent
2665if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2666
7be570e7
JM
2667Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2668hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2669value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2670every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2671that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2672hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2673will print a message like this:
2674
2675@smallexample
2676Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2677@end smallexample
2678
2679Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2680data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2681watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2682can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2683cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2684double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2685wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2686into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2687
2688If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2689to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2690Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2691time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2692able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2693warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2694
2695@smallexample
2696Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2697@end smallexample
2698
2699@noindent
2700If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2701
2702The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2703or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2704data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2705hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2706both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2707watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2708@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2709watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2710@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2711Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2712
2713If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2714any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2715kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2716
7be570e7
JM
2717@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2718(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2719they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2720which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2721being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2722and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2723rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2724way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2725@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2726
c906108c
SS
2727@quotation
2728@cindex watchpoints and threads
2729@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2730@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2731usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2732can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2733you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2734thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2735can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2736@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2737the expression.
53a5351d 2738
d4f3574e 2739@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2740@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2741have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2742watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2743single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2744change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2745confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2746software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2747when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2748watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2749@end quotation
c906108c 2750
6d2ebf8b 2751@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2752@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2753@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2754@cindex exception handlers
2755@cindex event handling
2756
2757You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2758kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2759shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2760
2761@table @code
2762@kindex catch
2763@item catch @var{event}
2764Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2765@table @code
2766@item throw
2767@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2768The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2769
2770@item catch
2771@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2772The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2773
2774@item exec
2775@kindex catch exec
2776A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2777
2778@item fork
2779@kindex catch fork
2780A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2781
2782@item vfork
2783@kindex catch vfork
2784A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2785
2786@item load
2787@itemx load @var{libname}
2788@kindex catch load
2789The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2790@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2791
2792@item unload
2793@itemx unload @var{libname}
2794@kindex catch unload
2795The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2796of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2797@end table
2798
2799@item tcatch @var{event}
2800Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2801automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2802
2803@end table
2804
2805Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2806
b37052ae 2807There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2808(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2809
2810@itemize @bullet
2811@item
2812If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2813control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2814raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2815returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2816simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2817that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2818you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2819disabled within interactive calls.
2820
2821@item
2822You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2823
2824@item
2825You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2826@end itemize
2827
2828@cindex raise exceptions
2829Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2830if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2831stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2832can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2833breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2834out where the exception was raised.
2835
2836To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2837knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2838raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2839which has the following ANSI C interface:
2840
474c8240 2841@smallexample
c906108c 2842 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2843 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2844 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2845@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2846
2847@noindent
2848To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2849unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2850(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2851
2852With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2853that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2854a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2855breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2856raised.
2857
2858
6d2ebf8b 2859@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2860@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2861
2862@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2863@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2864It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2865catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2866to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2867breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2868
2869With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2870where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2871delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2872their breakpoint numbers.
2873
2874It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2875automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2876when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex clear
2880@item clear
2881Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2882selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2883the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2884breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2885
2886@item clear @var{function}
2887@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2888Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2889
2890@item clear @var{linenum}
2891@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2892Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2893
2894@cindex delete breakpoints
2895@kindex delete
41afff9a 2896@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2897@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2898Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2899ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2900breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2901confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2902@end table
2903
6d2ebf8b 2904@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2905@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2906
2907@kindex disable breakpoints
2908@kindex enable breakpoints
2909Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2910prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2911it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2912that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2913
2914You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2915the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2916or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2917@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2918catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2919
2920A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2921states of enablement:
2922
2923@itemize @bullet
2924@item
2925Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2926with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2927@item
2928Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2929@item
2930Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2931disabled.
c906108c
SS
2932@item
2933Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2934immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2935set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2936@end itemize
2937
2938You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2939watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2940
2941@table @code
2942@kindex disable breakpoints
2943@kindex disable
41afff9a 2944@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2945@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2946Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2947listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2948options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2949case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2950@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2951
2952@kindex enable breakpoints
2953@kindex enable
c5394b80 2954@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2955Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2956become effective once again in stopping your program.
2957
c5394b80 2958@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2959Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2960of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2961
c5394b80 2962@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2963Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2964deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2965@end table
2966
d4f3574e
SS
2967@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2968@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2969Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2970,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2971subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2972the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2973breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2974breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2975stepping}.)
2976
6d2ebf8b 2977@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2978@subsection Break conditions
2979@cindex conditional breakpoints
2980@cindex breakpoint conditions
2981
2982@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2983@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2984The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2985specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2986breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2987programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2988a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2989and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2990
2991This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2992situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2993when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2994by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2995@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2996
2997Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2998since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2999it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3000and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3001one.
3002
3003Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3004your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3005that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3006format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3007unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3008that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3009program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3010breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3011conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3012purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3013(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3014
3015Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3016@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3017Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3018with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3019
c906108c
SS
3020You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3021The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3022@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3023catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3024
3025@table @code
3026@kindex condition
3027@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3028Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3029watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3030breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3031@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3032@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3033syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3034referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3035symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3036prints an error message:
3037
474c8240 3038@smallexample
d4f3574e 3039No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3040@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3041
3042@noindent
c906108c
SS
3043@value{GDBN} does
3044not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3045command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3046@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3047
3048@item condition @var{bnum}
3049Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3050an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3051@end table
3052
3053@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3054A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3055breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3056useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3057count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3058is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3059therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3060ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3061the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3062value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3063your program reaches it.
3064
3065@table @code
3066@kindex ignore
3067@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3068Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3069The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3070execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3071takes no action.
3072
3073To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3074a count of zero.
3075
3076When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3077breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3078@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3079Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3080
3081If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3082condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3083@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3084
3085You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3086as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3087is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3088variables}.
3089@end table
3090
3091Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3092
3093
6d2ebf8b 3094@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3095@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3096
3097@cindex breakpoint commands
3098You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3099commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3100example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3101enable other breakpoints.
3102
3103@table @code
3104@kindex commands
3105@kindex end
3106@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3107@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3108@itemx end
3109Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3110themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3111@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3112
3113To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3114follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3115
3116With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3117breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3118recently encountered).
3119@end table
3120
3121Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3122disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3123
3124You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3125use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3126that resumes execution.
3127
3128Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3129execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3130(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3131another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3132ambiguities about which list to execute.
3133
3134@kindex silent
3135If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3136usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3137be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3138then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3139see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3140meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3141
3142The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3143print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3144breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3145
3146For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3147value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3148
474c8240 3149@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3150break foo if x>0
3151commands
3152silent
3153printf "x is %d\n",x
3154cont
3155end
474c8240 3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3159you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3160of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3161erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3162to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3163so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3164command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3165
474c8240 3166@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3167break 403
3168commands
3169silent
3170set x = y + 4
3171cont
3172end
474c8240 3173@end smallexample
c906108c 3174
6d2ebf8b 3175@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3176@subsection Breakpoint menus
3177@cindex overloading
3178@cindex symbol overloading
3179
b37052ae 3180Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3181to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3182This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3183@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3184a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3185something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3186particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3187you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3188waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3189options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3190sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3191@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3192breakpoints.
3193
3194For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3195breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3196We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3197
3198@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3199@smallexample
3200@group
3201(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3202[0] cancel
3203[1] all
3204[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3205[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3206[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3207[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3208[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3209[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3210> 2 4 6
3211Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3212Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3213Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3214Multiple breakpoints were set.
3215Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3216 breakpoints.
3217(@value{GDBP})
3218@end group
3219@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3220
3221@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3222@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3223@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3224@c
3225@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3226@c
d4f3574e
SS
3227Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3228any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3229attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3230@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3231
474c8240 3232@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3233Cannot insert breakpoints.
3234The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3235@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3236
3237When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3238
3239@enumerate
3240@item
3241Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3242
3243@item
5d161b24 3244Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3245name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3246that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3247Then start your program again.
3248
3249@item
3250Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3251linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3252to nonsharable executables.
3253@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3254@c @end ifclear
3255
d4f3574e
SS
3256A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3257hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3258
3259@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3260@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3261@smallexample
3262Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3263You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3264@end smallexample
3265
3266@noindent
3267This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3268only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3269watchpoints it needs to insert.
3270
3271When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3272hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3273
3274
6d2ebf8b 3275@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3276@section Continuing and stepping
3277
3278@cindex stepping
3279@cindex continuing
3280@cindex resuming execution
3281@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3282completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3283one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3284line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3285particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3286your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3287it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3288@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3289
3290@table @code
3291@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3292@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3293@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3294@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3295@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3296@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3297Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3298any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3299@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3300ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3301@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3302
3303The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3304stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3305@code{continue} is ignored.
3306
d4f3574e
SS
3307The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3308debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3309purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3310@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3311@end table
3312
3313To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3314(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3315calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3316different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3317
3318A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3319(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3320beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3321is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3322and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3323interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3324
3325@table @code
3326@kindex step
41afff9a 3327@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3328@item step
3329Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3330line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3331abbreviated @code{s}.
3332
3333@quotation
3334@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3335@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3336@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3337@c distinction here.
3338@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3339within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3340execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3341debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3342is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3343without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3344below.
3345@end quotation
3346
4a92d011
EZ
3347The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3348line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3349@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3350to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3351the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3352called within the line.
c906108c 3353
d4f3574e
SS
3354Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3355number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3356@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3357on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3358was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3359
3360@item step @var{count}
3361Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3362breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3363@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3364
3365@kindex next
41afff9a 3366@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3367@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3368Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3369This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3370the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3371control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3372that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3373is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3374
3375An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3376
3377
3378@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3379@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3380@c
3381@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3382@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3383@c function are executed without stopping.
3384
d4f3574e
SS
3385The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3386source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3387@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3388
b90a5f51
CF
3389@kindex set step-mode
3390@item set step-mode
3391@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3392@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3393@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3394The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3395stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3396information rather than stepping over it.
3397
4a92d011
EZ
3398This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3399machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3400want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3401
3402@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3403Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3404debug information. This is the default.
3405
c906108c
SS
3406@kindex finish
3407@item finish
3408Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3409returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3410
3411Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3412,Returning from a function}).
3413
3414@kindex until
41afff9a 3415@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3416@item until
3417@itemx u
3418Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3419current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3420stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3421command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3422automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3423than the address of the jump.
3424
3425This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3426though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3427exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3428simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3429through the next iteration.
3430
3431@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3432stack frame.
3433
3434@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3435of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3436example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3437(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3438@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3439
474c8240 3440@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3441(@value{GDBP}) f
3442#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3443206 expand_input();
3444(@value{GDBP}) until
3445195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3446@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3447
3448This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3449generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3450start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3451written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3452to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3453expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3454statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3455
3456@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3457instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3458argument.
3459
3460@item until @var{location}
3461@itemx u @var{location}
3462Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3463reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3464the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3465,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3466and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3467
3468@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3469@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3470@item stepi
96a2c332 3471@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3472@itemx si
3473Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3474
3475It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3476instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3477instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3478Display,, Automatic display}.
3479
3480An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3481
3482@need 750
3483@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3484@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3485@item nexti
96a2c332 3486@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3487@itemx ni
3488Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3489proceed until the function returns.
3490
3491An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3492@end table
3493
6d2ebf8b 3494@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3495@section Signals
3496@cindex signals
3497
3498A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3499operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3500kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3501signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3502@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3503memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3504the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3505requested an alarm).
3506
3507@cindex fatal signals
3508Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3509functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3510errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3511program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3512@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3513fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3514
3515@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3516program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3517signal.
3518
3519@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3520Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3521@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3522(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3523but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3524You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3525
3526@table @code
3527@kindex info signals
3528@item info signals
96a2c332 3529@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3530Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3531handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3532the defined types of signals.
3533
d4f3574e 3534@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3535
3536@kindex handle
3537@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3538Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3539can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3540@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3541@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3542known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3543@end table
3544
3545@c @group
3546The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3547Their full names are:
3548
3549@table @code
3550@item nostop
3551@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3552still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3553
3554@item stop
3555@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3556the @code{print} keyword as well.
3557
3558@item print
3559@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3560
3561@item noprint
3562@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3563implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3564
3565@item pass
5ece1a18 3566@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3567@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3568can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3569and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3570
3571@item nopass
5ece1a18 3572@itemx ignore
c906108c 3573@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3574@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3575@end table
3576@c @end group
3577
d4f3574e
SS
3578When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3579program until you
c906108c
SS
3580continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3581effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3582after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3583command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3584program sees that signal when you continue.
3585
24f93129
EZ
3586The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3587non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3588@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3589erroneous signals.
3590
c906108c
SS
3591You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3592seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3593or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3594due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3595values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3596execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3597a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3598you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3599program a signal}.
c906108c 3600
6d2ebf8b 3601@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3602@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3603
3604When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3605programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3606breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3607
3608@table @code
3609@cindex breakpoints and threads
3610@cindex thread breakpoints
3611@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3612@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3613@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3614@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3615writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3616
3617Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3618to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3619particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3620numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3621column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3622
3623If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3624breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3625program.
3626
3627You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3628well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3629breakpoint condition, like this:
3630
3631@smallexample
2df3850c 3632(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3633@end smallexample
3634
3635@end table
3636
3637@cindex stopped threads
3638@cindex threads, stopped
3639Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3640@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3641allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3642switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3643underfoot.
3644
3645@cindex continuing threads
3646@cindex threads, continuing
3647Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3648executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3649like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3650
3651In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3652Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3653system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3654execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3655single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3656statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3657stops.
3658
3659You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3660continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3661thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3662first thread completes whatever you requested.
3663
3664On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3665thread to run.
3666
3667@table @code
3668@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3669Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3670locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3671current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3672mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3673``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3674stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3675when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3676function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3677like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3678thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3679@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3680
3681@item show scheduler-locking
3682Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3683@end table
3684
c906108c 3685
6d2ebf8b 3686@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3687@chapter Examining the Stack
3688
3689When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3690stopped and how it got there.
3691
3692@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3693Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3694is generated.
3695That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3696the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3697and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3698The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3699The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3700stack}.
3701
3702When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3703stack allow you to see all of this information.
3704
3705@cindex selected frame
3706One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3707@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3708particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3709your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3710special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3711interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3712
3713When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3714currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3715@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3716
3717@menu
3718* Frames:: Stack frames
3719* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3720* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3721* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3722
3723@end menu
3724
6d2ebf8b 3725@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3726@section Stack frames
3727
d4f3574e 3728@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3729@cindex stack frame
3730The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3731frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3732with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3733to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3734which the function is executing.
3735
3736@cindex initial frame
3737@cindex outermost frame
3738@cindex innermost frame
3739When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3740function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3741@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3742made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3743is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3744the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3745actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3746recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3747
3748@cindex frame pointer
3749Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3750stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3751kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3752address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3753in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3754going on in that frame.
3755
3756@cindex frame number
3757@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3758zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3759and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3760they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3761frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3762
6d2ebf8b
SS
3763@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3764@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3765@cindex frameless execution
3766Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 3767without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 3768@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3769@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 3770@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3771generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3772This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3773the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3774with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3775has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3776it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3777correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3778no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3779
3780@table @code
d4f3574e 3781@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3782@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3783@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3784The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3785and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3786address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3787@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3788
3789@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3790@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3791@item select-frame
3792The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3793to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3794@code{frame}.
3795@end table
3796
6d2ebf8b 3797@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3798@section Backtraces
3799
3800@cindex backtraces
3801@cindex tracebacks
3802@cindex stack traces
3803A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3804line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3805frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3806stack.
3807
3808@table @code
3809@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3810@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3811@item backtrace
3812@itemx bt
3813Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3814frames in the stack.
3815
3816You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3817character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3818
3819@item backtrace @var{n}
3820@itemx bt @var{n}
3821Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3822
3823@item backtrace -@var{n}
3824@itemx bt -@var{n}
3825Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3826@end table
3827
3828@kindex where
3829@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3830@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3831The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3832are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3833
3834Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3835The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3836print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3837line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3838counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3839line number.
3840
3841Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3842@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3843
3844@smallexample
3845@group
5d161b24 3846#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3847 at builtin.c:993
3848#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3849#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3850 at macro.c:71
3851(More stack frames follow...)
3852@end group
3853@end smallexample
3854
3855@noindent
3856The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3857value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3858code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3859
95f90d25
DJ
3860Most programs have a standard entry point---a place where system libraries
3861and startup code transition into user code. For C this is @code{main}.
3862When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace it will terminate
3863the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly system-specific (and generally
3864uninteresting) code. If you need to examine the startup code, then you can
3865change this behavior.
3866
3867@table @code
3868@item set backtrace-below-main off
3869Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
3870default.
3871
3872@item set backtrace-below-main
3873@itemx set backtrace-below-main on
3874Backtraces will continue past the user entry point to the top of the stack.
3875
3876@item show backtrace-below-main
3877Display the current backtrace policy.
3878@end table
3879
6d2ebf8b 3880@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3881@section Selecting a frame
3882
3883Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3884whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3885selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3886of the stack frame just selected.
3887
3888@table @code
d4f3574e 3889@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3890@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3891@item frame @var{n}
3892@itemx f @var{n}
3893Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3894(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3895innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3896@code{main}.
3897
3898@item frame @var{addr}
3899@itemx f @var{addr}
3900Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3901chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3902impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3903addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3904switches between them.
3905
c906108c
SS
3906On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3907select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3908
3909On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3910pointer and a program counter.
3911
3912On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3913pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3914@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3915@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3916@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3917
3918@kindex up
3919@item up @var{n}
3920Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3921advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3922that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3923
3924@kindex down
41afff9a 3925@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3926@item down @var{n}
3927Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3928advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3929that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3930abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3931@end table
3932
3933All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3934frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3935arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3936frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3937
3938@need 1000
3939For example:
3940
3941@smallexample
3942@group
3943(@value{GDBP}) up
3944#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3945 at env.c:10
394610 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3947@end group
3948@end smallexample
3949
3950After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3951prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
87885426
FN
3952You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3953editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3954@xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3955for details.
c906108c
SS
3956
3957@table @code
3958@kindex down-silently
3959@kindex up-silently
3960@item up-silently @var{n}
3961@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3962These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3963respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3964causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3965in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3966distracting.
3967@end table
3968
6d2ebf8b 3969@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3970@section Information about a frame
3971
3972There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3973stack frame.
3974
3975@table @code
3976@item frame
3977@itemx f
3978When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3979frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3980selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3981argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3982@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3983
3984@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3985@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3986@item info frame
3987@itemx info f
3988This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3989including:
3990
3991@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3992@item
3993the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3994@item
3995the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3996@item
3997the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3998@item
3999the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4000@item
4001the address of the frame's arguments
4002@item
d4f3574e
SS
4003the address of the frame's local variables
4004@item
c906108c
SS
4005the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4006@item
4007which registers were saved in the frame
4008@end itemize
4009
4010@noindent The verbose description is useful when
4011something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4012the usual conventions.
4013
4014@item info frame @var{addr}
4015@itemx info f @var{addr}
4016Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4017selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4018command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4019architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4020@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4021
4022@kindex info args
4023@item info args
4024Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4025
4026@item info locals
4027@kindex info locals
4028Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4029line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4030accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4031
c906108c 4032@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4033@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4034@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4035@item info catch
4036Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4037current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4038exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4039@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4040@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4041
c906108c
SS
4042@end table
4043
c906108c 4044
6d2ebf8b 4045@node Source
c906108c
SS
4046@chapter Examining Source Files
4047
4048@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4049information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4050used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4051the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4052(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4053execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4054source files by explicit command.
4055
7a292a7a 4056If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4057prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4058@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4059
4060@menu
4061* List:: Printing source lines
87885426 4062* Edit:: Editing source files
c906108c 4063* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4064* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4065* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4066@end menu
4067
6d2ebf8b 4068@node List
c906108c
SS
4069@section Printing source lines
4070
4071@kindex list
41afff9a 4072@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4073To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4074(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4075There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4076
4077Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4078
4079@table @code
4080@item list @var{linenum}
4081Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4082current source file.
4083
4084@item list @var{function}
4085Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4086@var{function}.
4087
4088@item list
4089Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4090@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4091printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4092as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4093Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4094
4095@item list -
4096Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4097@end table
4098
4099By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4100the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4101
4102@table @code
4103@kindex set listsize
4104@item set listsize @var{count}
4105Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4106the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4107
4108@kindex show listsize
4109@item show listsize
4110Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4111@end table
4112
4113Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4114so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4115than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4116argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4117each repetition moves up in the source file.
4118
4119@cindex linespec
4120In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4121@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4122of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4123Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4124
4125@table @code
4126@item list @var{linespec}
4127Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4128
4129@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4130Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4131linespecs.
4132
4133@item list ,@var{last}
4134Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4135
4136@item list @var{first},
4137Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4138
4139@item list +
4140Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4141
4142@item list -
4143Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4144
4145@item list
4146As described in the preceding table.
4147@end table
4148
4149Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4150kinds of linespec.
4151
4152@table @code
4153@item @var{number}
4154Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4155When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4156the same source file as the first linespec.
4157
4158@item +@var{offset}
4159Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4160When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4161two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4162first linespec.
4163
4164@item -@var{offset}
4165Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4166
4167@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4168Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4169
4170@item @var{function}
4171Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4172For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4173
4174@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4175Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4176function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4177file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4178identically named functions in different source files.
4179
4180@item *@var{address}
4181Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4182@var{address} may be any expression.
4183@end table
4184
87885426
FN
4185@node Edit
4186@section Editing source files
4187@cindex editing source files
4188
4189@kindex edit
4190@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4191To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4192The editing program of your choice
4193is invoked with the current line set to
4194the active line in the program.
4195Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4196want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4197
4198Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4199
4200@table @code
4201@item edit
4202Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4203
4204@item edit @var{number}
4205Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4206
4207@item edit @var{function}
4208Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4209
4210@item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4211Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4212
4213@item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4214Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4215function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4216file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4217identically named functions in different source files.
4218
4219@item edit *@var{address}
4220Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4221@var{address} may be any expression.
4222@end table
4223
4224@subsection Choosing your editor
4225You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4226@footnote{
4227The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4228following command-line syntax:
10998722 4229@smallexample
87885426 4230ex +@var{number} file
10998722
AC
4231@end smallexample
4232The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4233the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4234by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4235@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4236@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4237@smallexample
87885426
FN
4238EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4239export EDITOR
4240gdb ...
10998722 4241@end smallexample
87885426 4242or in the @code{csh} shell,
10998722 4243@smallexample
87885426
FN
4244setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4245gdb ...
10998722 4246@end smallexample
87885426 4247
6d2ebf8b 4248@node Search
c906108c
SS
4249@section Searching source files
4250@cindex searching
4251@kindex reverse-search
4252
4253There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4254regular expression.
4255
4256@table @code
4257@kindex search
4258@kindex forward-search
4259@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4260@itemx search @var{regexp}
4261The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4262starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4263@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4264synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4265@code{fo}.
4266
4267@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4268The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4269with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4270for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4271this command as @code{rev}.
4272@end table
c906108c 4273
6d2ebf8b 4274@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4275@section Specifying source directories
4276
4277@cindex source path
4278@cindex directories for source files
4279Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4280files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4281the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4282session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4283this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4284it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4285in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4286the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4287the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4288path.
4289
4290If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4291object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4292too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4293compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4294last resort.
4295
4296Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4297any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4298each line is in the file.
4299
4300@kindex directory
4301@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4302When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4303and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4304To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4305
4306@table @code
4307@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4308@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4309Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4310directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4311(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4312part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4313whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4314path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4315
4316@kindex cdir
4317@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4318@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4319@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4320@cindex compilation directory
4321@cindex current directory
4322@cindex working directory
4323@cindex directory, current
4324@cindex directory, compilation
4325You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4326directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4327working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4328tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4329session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4330directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4331
4332@item directory
4333Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4334
4335@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4336@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4337
4338@item show directories
4339@kindex show directories
4340Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4341@end table
4342
4343If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4344interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4345versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4346
4347@enumerate
4348@item
4349Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4350
4351@item
4352Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4353directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4354directories in one command.
4355@end enumerate
4356
6d2ebf8b 4357@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4358@section Source and machine code
4359
4360You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4361addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4362a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4363mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4364line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4365well as hex.
4366
4367@table @code
4368@kindex info line
4369@item info line @var{linespec}
4370Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4371source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4372the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4373source lines}).
4374@end table
4375
4376For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4377the object code for the first line of function
4378@code{m4_changequote}:
4379
d4f3574e
SS
4380@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4381@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4382@smallexample
96a2c332 4383(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4384Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4385@end smallexample
4386
4387@noindent
4388We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4389@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4390@smallexample
4391(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4392Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4393@end smallexample
4394
4395@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4396@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4397After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4398is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4399sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4400,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4401convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4402variables}).
4403
4404@table @code
4405@kindex disassemble
4406@cindex assembly instructions
4407@cindex instructions, assembly
4408@cindex machine instructions
4409@cindex listing machine instructions
4410@item disassemble
4411This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4412instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4413program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4414command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4415surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4416(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4417@end table
4418
c906108c
SS
4419The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4420HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4421
4422@smallexample
4423(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4424Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
44250x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
44260x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
44270x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
44280x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
44290x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
44300x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
44310x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
44320x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4433End of assembler dump.
4434@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4435
4436Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4437mnemonics or other syntax.
4438
4439@table @code
d4f3574e 4440@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4441@cindex assembly instructions
4442@cindex instructions, assembly
4443@cindex machine instructions
4444@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4445@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4446@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4447@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4448Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4449program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4450
4451Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4452can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4453The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4454assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4455@end table
4456
4457
6d2ebf8b 4458@node Data
c906108c
SS
4459@chapter Examining Data
4460
4461@cindex printing data
4462@cindex examining data
4463@kindex print
4464@kindex inspect
4465@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4466@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4467@c different window or something like that.
4468The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4469command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4470evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4471program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4472Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4473
4474@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4475@item print @var{expr}
4476@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4477@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4478value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4479you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4480@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4481formats}.
4482
4483@item print
4484@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4485If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4486@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4487conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4488@end table
4489
4490A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4491It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4492specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4493
7a292a7a 4494If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4495fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4496command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4497Table}.
c906108c
SS
4498
4499@menu
4500* Expressions:: Expressions
4501* Variables:: Program variables
4502* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4503* Output Formats:: Output formats
4504* Memory:: Examining memory
4505* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4506* Print Settings:: Print settings
4507* Value History:: Value history
4508* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4509* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4510* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
53c69bd7 4511* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
29e57380 4512* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4513* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
a0eb71c5
KB
4514* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4515 character set than GDB does
c906108c
SS
4516@end menu
4517
6d2ebf8b 4518@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4519@section Expressions
4520
4521@cindex expressions
4522@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4523compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4524by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
e2e0bcd1
JB
4525@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4526casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4527you compiled your program to include this information; see
4528@ref{Compilation}.
c906108c 4529
d4f3574e
SS
4530@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4531the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4532you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4533memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4534
c906108c
SS
4535Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4536this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4537Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4538languages.
4539
4540In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4541expressions regardless of your programming language.
4542
4543Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4544useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4545at that address in memory.
4546@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4547
4548@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4549to programming languages:
4550
4551@table @code
4552@item @@
4553@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4554@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4555
4556@item ::
4557@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4558function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4559
4560@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4561@cindex type casting memory
4562@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4563@cindex casts, to view memory
4564@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4565Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4566memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4567pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4568a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4569normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4570@end table
4571
6d2ebf8b 4572@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4573@section Program variables
4574
4575The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4576in your program.
4577
4578Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4579(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4580
4581@itemize @bullet
4582@item
4583global (or file-static)
4584@end itemize
4585
5d161b24 4586@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4587
4588@itemize @bullet
4589@item
4590visible according to the scope rules of the
4591programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4592@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4593
4594@noindent This means that in the function
4595
474c8240 4596@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4597foo (a)
4598 int a;
4599@{
4600 bar (a);
4601 @{
4602 int b = test ();
4603 bar (b);
4604 @}
4605@}
474c8240 4606@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4607
4608@noindent
4609you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4610executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4611examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4612the block where @code{b} is declared.
4613
4614@cindex variable name conflict
4615There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4616scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4617in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4618function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4619happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4620you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4621using the colon-colon notation:
4622
d4f3574e 4623@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4624@iftex
4625@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4626@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4627@end iftex
474c8240 4628@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4629@var{file}::@var{variable}
4630@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4631@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4632
4633@noindent
4634Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4635static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4636make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4637to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4638
474c8240 4639@smallexample
c906108c 4640(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4641@end smallexample
c906108c 4642
b37052ae 4643@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4644This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4645use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4646scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4647@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4648@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4649
4650@cindex wrong values
4651@cindex variable values, wrong
4652@quotation
4653@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4654wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4655scope, and just before exit.
4656@end quotation
4657You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4658This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4659set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4660stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4661values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4662also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4663after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4664variable definitions may be gone.
4665
4666This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4667To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4668when compiling.
4669
d4f3574e
SS
4670@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4671Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4672unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4673opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4674offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4675might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4676happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4677
474c8240 4678@smallexample
d4f3574e 4679No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4680@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4681
4682To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4683different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4684formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4685supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4686in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4687to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4688debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4689Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4690information.
4691
4692
6d2ebf8b 4693@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4694@section Artificial arrays
4695
4696@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4697@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4698It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4699same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4700dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4701program.
4702
4703You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4704@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4705operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4706and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4707of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4708the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4709argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4710following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4711example. If a program says
4712
474c8240 4713@smallexample
c906108c 4714int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4715@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4716
4717@noindent
4718you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4719
474c8240 4720@smallexample
c906108c 4721p *array@@len
474c8240 4722@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4723
4724The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4725with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4726subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4727Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4728(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4729
4730Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4731This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4732The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 4733@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4734(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4735$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4736@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4737
4738As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4739@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 4740the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 4741@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4742(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4743$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4744@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4745
4746Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4747moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4748actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4749of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4750to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4751variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4752interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4753instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4754structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4755in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4756
474c8240 4757@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4758set $i = 0
4759p dtab[$i++]->fv
4760@key{RET}
4761@key{RET}
4762@dots{}
474c8240 4763@end smallexample
c906108c 4764
6d2ebf8b 4765@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4766@section Output formats
4767
4768@cindex formatted output
4769@cindex output formats
4770By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4771this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4772in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4773at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4774these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4775
4776The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4777already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4778@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4779letters supported are:
4780
4781@table @code
4782@item x
4783Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4784hexadecimal.
4785
4786@item d
4787Print as integer in signed decimal.
4788
4789@item u
4790Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4791
4792@item o
4793Print as integer in octal.
4794
4795@item t
4796Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4797@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4798used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4799see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4800
4801@item a
4802@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4803@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4804Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4805the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4806where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4807
474c8240 4808@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4809(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4810$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 4811@end smallexample
c906108c 4812
3d67e040
EZ
4813@noindent
4814The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4815@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4816
c906108c
SS
4817@item c
4818Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4819
4820@item f
4821Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4822using typical floating point syntax.
4823@end table
4824
4825For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4826
474c8240 4827@smallexample
c906108c 4828p/x $pc
474c8240 4829@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4830
4831@noindent
4832Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4833names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4834
4835To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4836you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4837expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4838
6d2ebf8b 4839@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4840@section Examining memory
4841
4842You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4843any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4844
4845@cindex examining memory
4846@table @code
41afff9a 4847@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4848@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4849@itemx x @var{addr}
4850@itemx x
4851Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4852@end table
4853
4854@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4855much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4856expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4857If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4858Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4859
4860@table @r
4861@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4862The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4863how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4864@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4865@c 4.1.2.
4866
4867@item @var{f}, the display format
4868The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4869@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4870The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4871The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4872
4873@item @var{u}, the unit size
4874The unit size is any of
4875
4876@table @code
4877@item b
4878Bytes.
4879@item h
4880Halfwords (two bytes).
4881@item w
4882Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4883@item g
4884Giant words (eight bytes).
4885@end table
4886
4887Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4888default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4889@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4890
4891@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4892@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4893memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4894it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4895@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4896@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4897other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4898the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4899starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4900a value from memory).
4901@end table
4902
4903For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4904(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4905starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4906words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4907@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4908
4909Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4910letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4911unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4912specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4913(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4914
4915Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4916and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4917@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4918including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4919alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4920Code,,Source and machine code}.
4921
4922All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4923easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4924you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4925instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4926with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4927the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4928for successive uses of @code{x}.
4929
4930@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4931The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4932in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4933would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4934subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4935@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4936examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4937@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4938the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4939
4940If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4941are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4942address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4943
6d2ebf8b 4944@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4945@section Automatic display
4946@cindex automatic display
4947@cindex display of expressions
4948
4949If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4950(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4951display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4952Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4953to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4954The automatic display looks like this:
4955
474c8240 4956@smallexample
c906108c
SS
49572: foo = 38
49583: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 4959@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4960
4961@noindent
4962This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4963displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4964specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4965whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4966format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4967or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4968supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4969
4970@table @code
4971@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4972@item display @var{expr}
4973Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4974each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4975
4976@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4977
d4f3574e 4978@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4979For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4980count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4981arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4982@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4983
4984@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4985For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4986number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4987be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4988doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4989@end table
4990
4991For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4992instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4993is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4994
4995@table @code
4996@kindex delete display
4997@kindex undisplay
4998@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4999@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5000Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5001
5002@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5003(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5004
5005@kindex disable display
5006@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5007Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5008item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5009enabled again later.
5010
5011@kindex enable display
5012@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5013Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5014again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5015
5016@item display
5017Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5018done when your program stops.
5019
5020@kindex info display
5021@item info display
5022Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5023automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5024values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5025It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5026because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5027@end table
5028
5029If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5030sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5031expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5032variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5033@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5034@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5035continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5036there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5037automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5038is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5039
6d2ebf8b 5040@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
5041@section Print settings
5042
5043@cindex format options
5044@cindex print settings
5045@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5046and symbols are printed.
5047
5048@noindent
5049These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5050
5051@table @code
5052@kindex set print address
5053@item set print address
5054@itemx set print address on
5055@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5056traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5057even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5058is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5059@code{set print address on}:
5060
5061@smallexample
5062@group
5063(@value{GDBP}) f
5064#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5065 at input.c:530
5066530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5067@end group
5068@end smallexample
5069
5070@item set print address off
5071Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5072this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5073
5074@smallexample
5075@group
5076(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5077(@value{GDBP}) f
5078#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5079530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5080@end group
5081@end smallexample
5082
5083You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5084dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5085@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5086all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5087
5088@kindex show print address
5089@item show print address
5090Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5091@end table
5092
5093When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5094closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5095identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5096source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5097@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5098you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5099it prints a symbolic address:
5100
5101@table @code
5102@kindex set print symbol-filename
5103@item set print symbol-filename on
5104Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5105symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5106
5107@item set print symbol-filename off
5108Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5109default.
5110
5111@kindex show print symbol-filename
5112@item show print symbol-filename
5113Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5114line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5115@end table
5116
5117Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5118numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5119number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5120
5121Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5122printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5123
5124@table @code
5125@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5126@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5127Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5128offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5129@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5130to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5131
5132@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5133@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5134Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5135symbolic address.
5136@end table
5137
5138@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5139@cindex pointer, finding referent
5140If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5141@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5142and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5143@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5144For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5145at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5146
474c8240 5147@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5148(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5149(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5150$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5151@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5152
5153@quotation
5154@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5155does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5156the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5157@end quotation
5158
5159Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5160
5161@table @code
5162@kindex set print array
5163@item set print array
5164@itemx set print array on
5165Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5166but uses more space. The default is off.
5167
5168@item set print array off
5169Return to compressed format for arrays.
5170
5171@kindex show print array
5172@item show print array
5173Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5174arrays.
5175
5176@kindex set print elements
5177@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5178Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5179If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5180printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5181This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5182When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5183Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5184
5185@kindex show print elements
5186@item show print elements
5187Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5188If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5189
5190@kindex set print null-stop
5191@item set print null-stop
5192Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5193@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5194contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5195The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5196
5197@kindex set print pretty
5198@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5199Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5200per line, like this:
5201
5202@smallexample
5203@group
5204$1 = @{
5205 next = 0x0,
5206 flags = @{
5207 sweet = 1,
5208 sour = 1
5209 @},
5210 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5211@}
5212@end group
5213@end smallexample
5214
5215@item set print pretty off
5216Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5217
5218@smallexample
5219@group
5220$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5221meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5222@end group
5223@end smallexample
5224
5225@noindent
5226This is the default format.
5227
5228@kindex show print pretty
5229@item show print pretty
5230Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5231
5232@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5233@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5234Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5235@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5236character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5237best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5238high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5239
5240@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5241Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5242international character sets, and is the default.
5243
5244@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5245@item show print sevenbit-strings
5246Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5247
5248@kindex set print union
5249@item set print union on
5d161b24 5250Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5251is the default setting.
5252
5253@item set print union off
5254Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5255
5256@kindex show print union
5257@item show print union
5258Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5259structures.
5260
5261For example, given the declarations
5262
5263@smallexample
5264typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5265typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5266typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5267 Bug_forms;
5268
5269struct thing @{
5270 Species it;
5271 union @{
5272 Tree_forms tree;
5273 Bug_forms bug;
5274 @} form;
5275@};
5276
5277struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5278@end smallexample
5279
5280@noindent
5281with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5282
5283@smallexample
5284$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5285@end smallexample
5286
5287@noindent
5288and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5289
5290@smallexample
5291$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5292@end smallexample
5293@end table
5294
c906108c
SS
5295@need 1000
5296@noindent
b37052ae 5297These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5298
5299@table @code
5300@cindex demangling
5301@kindex set print demangle
5302@item set print demangle
5303@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5304Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5305(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5306linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5307
5308@kindex show print demangle
5309@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5310Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5311
5312@kindex set print asm-demangle
5313@item set print asm-demangle
5314@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5315Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5316in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5317The default is off.
5318
5319@kindex show print asm-demangle
5320@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5321Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5322or demangled form.
5323
5324@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5325@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5326@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5327@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5328Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5329represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5330
5331@table @code
5332@item auto
5333Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5334
5335@item gnu
b37052ae 5336Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5337This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5338
5339@item hp
b37052ae 5340Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5341
5342@item lucid
b37052ae 5343Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5344
5345@item arm
b37052ae 5346Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5347@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5348debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5349require further enhancement to permit that.
5350
5351@end table
5352If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5353
5354@kindex show demangle-style
5355@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5356Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5357
5358@kindex set print object
5359@item set print object
5360@itemx set print object on
5361When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5362(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5363the virtual function table.
5364
5365@item set print object off
5366Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5367virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5368
5369@kindex show print object
5370@item show print object
5371Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5372
5373@kindex set print static-members
5374@item set print static-members
5375@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5376Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5377
5378@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5379Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5380
5381@kindex show print static-members
5382@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5383Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5384
5385@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5386@kindex set print vtbl
5387@item set print vtbl
5388@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5389Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5390(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5391ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5392
5393@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5394Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5395
5396@kindex show print vtbl
5397@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5398Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5399@end table
c906108c 5400
6d2ebf8b 5401@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5402@section Value history
5403
5404@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5405Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5406@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5407Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5408(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5409When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5410since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5411symbol table.
5412
5413@cindex @code{$}
5414@cindex @code{$$}
5415@cindex history number
5416The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5417refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5418@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5419printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5420history number.
5421
5422To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5423history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5424remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5425the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5426@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5427is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5428@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5429
5430For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5431want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5432
474c8240 5433@smallexample
c906108c 5434p *$
474c8240 5435@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5436
5437If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5438to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5439
474c8240 5440@smallexample
c906108c 5441p *$.next
474c8240 5442@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5443
5444@noindent
5445You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5446command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5447
5448Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5449@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5450
474c8240 5451@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5452print x
5453set x=5
474c8240 5454@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5455
5456@noindent
5457then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5458remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5459
5460@table @code
5461@kindex show values
5462@item show values
5463Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5464This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5465values} does not change the history.
5466
5467@item show values @var{n}
5468Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5469
5470@item show values +
5471Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5472values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5473@end table
5474
5475Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5476same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5477
6d2ebf8b 5478@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5479@section Convenience variables
5480
5481@cindex convenience variables
5482@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5483@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5484exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5485setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5486of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5487
5488Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5489@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5490the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5491(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5492by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5493
5494You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5495expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5496For example:
5497
474c8240 5498@smallexample
c906108c 5499set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5500@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5501
5502@noindent
5503would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5504@code{object_ptr}.
5505
5506Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5507value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5508value with another assignment at any time.
5509
5510Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5511variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5512that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5513variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5514
5515@table @code
5516@kindex show convenience
5517@item show convenience
5518Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5519Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5520@end table
5521
5522One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5523incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5524a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5525
474c8240 5526@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5527set $i = 0
5528print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5529@end smallexample
c906108c 5530
d4f3574e
SS
5531@noindent
5532Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5533
5534Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5535values likely to be useful.
5536
5537@table @code
41afff9a 5538@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5539@item $_
5540The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5541the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5542commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5543set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5544and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5545except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5546to the type of @code{$__}.
5547
41afff9a 5548@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5549@item $__
5550The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5551to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5552to match the format in which the data was printed.
5553
5554@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5555@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5556The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5557the program being debugged terminates.
5558@end table
5559
53a5351d
JM
5560On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5561begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5562name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5563
6d2ebf8b 5564@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5565@section Registers
5566
5567@cindex registers
5568You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5569with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5570for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5571your machine.
5572
5573@table @code
5574@kindex info registers
5575@item info registers
5576Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
c85508ee 5577and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5578
5579@kindex info all-registers
5580@cindex floating point registers
5581@item info all-registers
5582Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
c85508ee 5583and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5584
5585@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5586Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5587As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5588the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5589the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5590@end table
5591
5592@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5593expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5594architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5595@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5596the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5597pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5598register that contains the processor status. For example,
5599you could print the program counter in hex with
5600
474c8240 5601@smallexample
c906108c 5602p/x $pc
474c8240 5603@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5604
5605@noindent
5606or print the instruction to be executed next with
5607
474c8240 5608@smallexample
c906108c 5609x/i $pc
474c8240 5610@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5611
5612@noindent
5613or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5614one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5615memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5616stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5617stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5618regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5619see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5620
474c8240 5621@smallexample
c906108c 5622set $sp += 4
474c8240 5623@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5624
5625Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5626your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5627so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5628shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5629registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5630can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5631is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5632
5633@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5634integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5635special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5636registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5637to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5638(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5639@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5640
5641Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5642means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5643the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5644sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5645coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5646programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5647cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5648that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5649prints the data in both formats.
5650
5651Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5652(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5653value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5654were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5655true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5656frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5657
5658However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5659code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5660@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5661frame makes no difference.
5662
6d2ebf8b 5663@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5664@section Floating point hardware
5665@cindex floating point
5666
5667Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5668you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5669
5670@table @code
5671@kindex info float
5672@item info float
5673Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5674point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5675floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5676the ARM and x86 machines.
5677@end table
c906108c 5678
e76f1f2e
AC
5679@node Vector Unit
5680@section Vector Unit
5681@cindex vector unit
5682
5683Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5684more information about the status of the vector unit.
5685
5686@table @code
5687@kindex info vector
5688@item info vector
5689Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5690layout vary depending on the hardware.
5691@end table
5692
29e57380 5693@node Memory Region Attributes
16d9dec6 5694@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5695@cindex memory region attributes
5696
5697@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5698required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5699to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5700use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5701
5702Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5703memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5704accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5705been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5706all memory.
5707
5708When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5709to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5710
5711@table @code
5712@kindex mem
bfac230e
DH
5713@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5714Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5715attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5716special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5717(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
29e57380
C
5718
5719@kindex delete mem
5720@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5721Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5722
5723@kindex disable mem
5724@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5725Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5726A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5727It may be enabled again later.
5728
5729@kindex enable mem
5730@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5731Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5732
5733@kindex info mem
5734@item info mem
5735Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5736for each region.
5737
5738@table @emph
5739@item Memory Region Number
5740@item Enabled or Disabled.
5741Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5742Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5743
5744@item Lo Address
5745The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5746
5747@item Hi Address
5748The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5749
5750@item Attributes
5751The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5752@end table
5753@end table
5754
5755
5756@subsection Attributes
5757
5758@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5759The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5760write accesses to a memory region.
5761
5762While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5763memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5764etc. from accessing memory.
5765
5766@table @code
5767@item ro
5768Memory is read only.
5769@item wo
5770Memory is write only.
5771@item rw
6ca652b0 5772Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5773@end table
5774
5775@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5776The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5777accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5778require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5779specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5780
5781@table @code
5782@item 8
5783Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5784@item 16
5785Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5786@item 32
5787Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5788@item 64
5789Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5790@end table
5791
5792@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5793@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5794@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5795@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5796@c
5797@c @table @code
5798@c @item hwbreak
5799@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5800@c @item swbreak (default)
5801@c @end table
5802
5803@subsubsection Data Cache
5804The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5805memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5806protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5807does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5808registers.
5809
5810@table @code
5811@item cache
5812Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
5813@item nocache
5814Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5815@end table
5816
5817@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5818@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5819@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5820@c
5821@c @table @code
5822@c @item verify
5823@c @item noverify (default)
5824@c @end table
5825
16d9dec6
MS
5826@node Dump/Restore Files
5827@section Copy between memory and a file
5828@cindex dump/restore files
5829@cindex append data to a file
5830@cindex dump data to a file
5831@cindex restore data from a file
5832@kindex dump
5833@kindex append
5834@kindex restore
5835
5836The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5837for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5838into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5839file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5840intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5841
5842@table @code
5843@kindex dump binary
5844@kindex append binary
5845@item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5846Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5847raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5848
5849@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5850Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5851raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5852
5853@item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5854Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5855
5856@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5857Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5858
5859@kindex dump ihex
5860@item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5861Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5862intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5863
5864@item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5865Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5866
5867@kindex dump srec
5868@item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5869Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5870srec format file @var{filename}.
5871
5872@item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5873Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5874
5875@kindex dump tekhex
5876@item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5877Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5878tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5879
5880@item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5881Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5882
42f9b0a5 5883@item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
16d9dec6
MS
5884Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5885command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5886raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5887@var{binary} after the filename.
5888
5889If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5890contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5891they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5892a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5893from that location.
5894
5895If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5896file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5897These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5898the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5899
5900@end table
5901
a0eb71c5
KB
5902@node Character Sets
5903@section Character Sets
5904@cindex character sets
5905@cindex charset
5906@cindex translating between character sets
5907@cindex host character set
5908@cindex target character set
5909
5910If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5911represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5912@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5913you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5914character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5915@dfn{target character set}.
5916
5917For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5918uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5919remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5920running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5921then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5922@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5923target-charset ebcdic-us}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5924@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5925character and string literals in expressions.
5926
5927@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5928the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5929target-charset} command, described below.
5930
5931Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5932support:
5933
5934@table @code
5935@item set target-charset @var{charset}
5936@kindex set target-charset
5937Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5938character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you invoke the
5939@code{set target-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists
5940the character sets it supports.
5941@end table
5942
5943@table @code
5944@item set host-charset @var{charset}
5945@kindex set host-charset
5946Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
5947
5948By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
5949system it is running on; you can override that default using the
5950@code{set host-charset} command.
5951
5952@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
5953set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
5954indicate which can be host character sets, but if you invoke the
5955@code{set host-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists the
5956character sets it supports, placing an asterisk (@samp{*}) after those
5957it can use as a host character set.
5958
5959@item set charset @var{charset}
5960@kindex set charset
5961Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. If you
5962invoke the @code{set charset} command with no argument, it lists the
5963character sets it supports. @value{GDBN} can only use certain character
5964sets as its host character set; it marks those in the list with an
5965asterisk (@samp{*}).
5966
5967@item show charset
5968@itemx show host-charset
5969@itemx show target-charset
5970@kindex show charset
5971@kindex show host-charset
5972@kindex show target-charset
5973Show the current host and target charsets. The @code{show host-charset}
5974and @code{show target-charset} commands are synonyms for @code{show
5975charset}.
5976
5977@end table
5978
5979@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
5980sets:
5981
5982@table @code
5983
5984@item ASCII
5985@cindex ASCII character set
5986Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
5987character set.
5988
5989@item ISO-8859-1
5990@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
5991@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
5992The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends ASCII with accented
5993characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
5994this as its host character set.
5995
5996@item EBCDIC-US
5997@itemx IBM1047
5998@cindex EBCDIC character set
5999@cindex IBM1047 character set
6000Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6001mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6002@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6003
6004@end table
6005
6006Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6007GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6008encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6009
6010Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6011Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6012@file{charset-test.c}:
6013
6014@smallexample
6015#include <stdio.h>
6016
6017char ascii_hello[]
6018 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6019 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6020char ibm1047_hello[]
6021 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6022 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6023
6024main ()
6025@{
6026 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6027@}
10998722 6028@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6029
6030In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6031containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6032encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6033
6034We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6035
6036@smallexample
6037$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6038$ gdb -nw charset-test
6039GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6040Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6041@dots{}
6042(gdb)
10998722 6043@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6044
6045We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6046@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6047strings:
6048
6049@smallexample
6050(gdb) show charset
6051The current host and target character set is `iso-8859-1'.
6052(gdb)
10998722 6053@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6054
6055For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6056initial character set:
6057@smallexample
6058(gdb) set charset ascii
6059(gdb) show charset
6060The current host and target character set is `ascii'.
6061(gdb)
10998722 6062@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6063
6064Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6065host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6066characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6067them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6068@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6069
6070@smallexample
6071(gdb) print ascii_hello
6072$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6073(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6074$2 = 72 'H'
6075(gdb)
10998722 6076@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6077
6078@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6079literals you use in expressions:
6080
6081@smallexample
6082(gdb) print '+'
6083$3 = 43 '+'
6084(gdb)
10998722 6085@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6086
6087The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6088character.
6089
6090@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6091target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6092character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6093
6094@smallexample
6095(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6096$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6097(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6098$5 = 200 '\310'
6099(gdb)
10998722 6100@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6101
6102If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} command without an argument,
6103@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6104
6105@smallexample
6106(gdb) set target-charset
6107Valid character sets are:
6108 ascii *
6109 iso-8859-1 *
6110 ebcdic-us
6111 ibm1047
6112* - can be used as a host character set
10998722 6113@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6114
6115We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6116program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6117@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6118target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6119@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6120
6121@smallexample
6122(gdb) set target-charset ibm1047
6123(gdb) show charset
6124The current host character set is `ascii'.
6125The current target character set is `ibm1047'.
6126(gdb) print ascii_hello
6127$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6128(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6129$7 = 72 '\110'
6130(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6131$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6132(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6133$9 = 200 'H'
6134(gdb)
10998722 6135@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6136
6137As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6138string literals you use in expressions:
6139
6140@smallexample
6141(gdb) print '+'
6142$10 = 78 '+'
6143(gdb)
10998722 6144@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6145
6146The IBM1047 character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6147character.
6148
6149
e2e0bcd1
JB
6150@node Macros
6151@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6152
6153Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6154``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6155@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6156the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6157where it was defined.
6158
6159You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6160with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6161include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6162with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6163
6164A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6165and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6166points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6167no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6168uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6169@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6170see @ref{List}.
6171
6172At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6173token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6174variable-arity macros.
6175
6176Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6177macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6178the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6179
6180@table @code
6181
6182@kindex macro expand
6183@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6184@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6185@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6186@item macro expand @var{expression}
6187@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6188Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6189@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6190not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6191it can be any string of tokens.
6192
6193@kindex macro expand-once
6194@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6195@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6196@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6197expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6198@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6199left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6200particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6201expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6202parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6203can be any string of tokens.
6204
475b0867 6205@kindex info macro
e2e0bcd1
JB
6206@cindex macro definition, showing
6207@cindex definition, showing a macro's
475b0867 6208@item info macro @var{macro}
e2e0bcd1
JB
6209Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6210source location where that definition was established.
6211
6212@kindex macro define
6213@cindex user-defined macros
6214@cindex defining macros interactively
6215@cindex macros, user-defined
6216@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6217@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6218@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6219preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6220by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6221command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6222second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6223given in @var{arglist}.
6224
6225A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6226evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6227undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6228definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6229well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6230
6231@kindex macro undef
6232@item macro undef @var{macro}
6233@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6234definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6235definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6236above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6237debugged.
6238
6239@end table
6240
6241@cindex macros, example of debugging with
6242Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6243show our source files:
6244
6245@smallexample
6246$ cat sample.c
6247#include <stdio.h>
6248#include "sample.h"
6249
6250#define M 42
6251#define ADD(x) (M + x)
6252
6253main ()
6254@{
6255#define N 28
6256 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6257#undef N
6258 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6259#define N 1729
6260 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6261@}
6262$ cat sample.h
6263#define Q <
6264$
6265@end smallexample
6266
6267Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6268We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6269compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6270information.
6271
6272@smallexample
6273$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6274$
6275@end smallexample
6276
6277Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6278
6279@smallexample
6280$ gdb -nw sample
6281GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6282Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6283GDB is free software, @dots{}
6284(gdb)
6285@end smallexample
6286
6287We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6288program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6289to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6290
6291@smallexample
6292(gdb) list main
62933
62944 #define M 42
62955 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
62966
62977 main ()
62988 @{
62999 #define N 28
630010 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
630111 #undef N
630212 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6303(gdb) info macro ADD
e2e0bcd1
JB
6304Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6305#define ADD(x) (M + x)
475b0867 6306(gdb) info macro Q
e2e0bcd1
JB
6307Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6308 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6309#define Q <
6310(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6311expands to: (42 + 1)
6312(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6313expands to: once (M + 1)
6314(gdb)
6315@end smallexample
6316
6317In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6318the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6319@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6320which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6321
6322Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6323the source line of the current stack frame:
6324
6325@smallexample
6326(gdb) break main
6327Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6328(gdb) run
6329Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6330
6331Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
633210 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6333(gdb)
6334@end smallexample
6335
6336At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6337
6338@smallexample
475b0867 6339(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6340Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6341#define N 28
6342(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6343expands to: 28 < 42
6344(gdb) print N Q M
6345$1 = 1
6346(gdb)
6347@end smallexample
6348
6349As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6350give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6351thereof) in force at each point:
6352
6353@smallexample
6354(gdb) next
6355Hello, world!
635612 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6357(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6358The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6359at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6360(gdb) next
6361We're so creative.
636214 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
475b0867 6363(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6364Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6365#define N 1729
6366(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6367expands to: 1729 < 42
6368(gdb) print N Q M
6369$2 = 0
6370(gdb)
6371@end smallexample
6372
6373
b37052ae
EZ
6374@node Tracepoints
6375@chapter Tracepoints
6376@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6377@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6378
6379@cindex tracepoints
6380In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6381the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6382anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6383depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6384might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6385fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6386to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6387
6388Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6389specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6390arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6391Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6392those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6393expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6394for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6395a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6396in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6397values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6398unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6399
6400The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
6401targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6402to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6403stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6404tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
6405
6406This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6407
6408@menu
6409* Set Tracepoints::
6410* Analyze Collected Data::
6411* Tracepoint Variables::
6412@end menu
6413
6414@node Set Tracepoints
6415@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6416
6417Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6418tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6419tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6420breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6421one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6422tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6423work on.
6424
6425For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6426of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6427it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6428local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6429commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6430tracepoint was hit.
6431
6432This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6433conditions and actions.
6434
6435@menu
6436* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6437* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6438* Tracepoint Passcounts::
6439* Tracepoint Actions::
6440* Listing Tracepoints::
6441* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6442@end menu
6443
6444@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6445@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6446
6447@table @code
6448@cindex set tracepoint
6449@kindex trace
6450@item trace
6451The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6452Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6453the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6454defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6455debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6456program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6457doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6458cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6459running.
6460
6461Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6462
6463@smallexample
6464(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6465
6466(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6467
6468(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6469
6470(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6471
6472(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6473@end smallexample
6474
6475@noindent
6476You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6477
6478@vindex $tpnum
6479@cindex last tracepoint number
6480@cindex recent tracepoint number
6481@cindex tracepoint number
6482The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6483of the most recently set tracepoint.
6484
6485@kindex delete tracepoint
6486@cindex tracepoint deletion
6487@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6488Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6489default is to delete all tracepoints.
6490
6491Examples:
6492
6493@smallexample
6494(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6495
6496(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6497@end smallexample
6498
6499@noindent
6500You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6501@end table
6502
6503@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6504@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6505
6506@table @code
6507@kindex disable tracepoint
6508@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6509Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6510@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6511the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6512a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6513
6514@kindex enable tracepoint
6515@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6516Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6517tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6518run.
6519@end table
6520
6521@node Tracepoint Passcounts
6522@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6523
6524@table @code
6525@kindex passcount
6526@cindex tracepoint pass count
6527@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6528Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6529automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6530@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6531the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6532@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6533passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6534given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6535user.
6536
6537Examples:
6538
6539@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
6540(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6541@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
6542
6543(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 6544@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
6545(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6546(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6547(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6548(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6549(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6550(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
6551@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6552@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6553@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
6554@end smallexample
6555@end table
6556
6557@node Tracepoint Actions
6558@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6559
6560@table @code
6561@kindex actions
6562@cindex tracepoint actions
6563@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6564This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6565tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6566specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6567recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6568@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6569actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6570terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6571far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6572@code{while-stepping}.
6573
6574@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6575To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6576and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6577
6578@smallexample
6579(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6580
6826cf00 6581(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 6582
6826cf00 6583(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
6584@end smallexample
6585
6586In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6587commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6588hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6589following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6590followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6591@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6592@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6593@code{end} command.
6594
6595@smallexample
6596(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6597(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6598Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6599> collect bar,baz
6600> collect $regs
6601> while-stepping 12
6602 > collect $fp, $sp
6603 > end
6604end
6605@end smallexample
6606
6607@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6608@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6609Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6610This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6611In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6612special arguments are supported:
6613
6614@table @code
6615@item $regs
6616collect all registers
6617
6618@item $args
6619collect all function arguments
6620
6621@item $locals
6622collect all local variables.
6623@end table
6624
6625You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6626with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6627arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6628
f5c37c66
EZ
6629The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6630particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6631
b37052ae
EZ
6632@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6633@item while-stepping @var{n}
6634Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6635new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6636followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6637its own @code{end} command):
6638
6639@smallexample
6640> while-stepping 12
6641 > collect $regs, myglobal
6642 > end
6643>
6644@end smallexample
6645
6646@noindent
6647You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6648@code{stepping}.
6649@end table
6650
6651@node Listing Tracepoints
6652@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6653
6654@table @code
6655@kindex info tracepoints
6656@cindex information about tracepoints
6657@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6658Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6659a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6660defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6661shown:
6662
6663@itemize @bullet
6664@item
6665its number
6666@item
6667whether it is enabled or disabled
6668@item
6669its address
6670@item
6671its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6672@item
6673its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6674@item
6675where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6676@item
6677its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6678@end itemize
6679
6680@smallexample
6681(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6682Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
66831 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
66842 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
66853 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6686(@value{GDBP})
6687@end smallexample
6688
6689@noindent
6690This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6691@end table
6692
6693@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6694@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6695
6696@table @code
6697@kindex tstart
6698@cindex start a new trace experiment
6699@cindex collected data discarded
6700@item tstart
6701This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6702begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6703the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6704experiment.
6705
6706@kindex tstop
6707@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6708@item tstop
6709This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6710stops collecting data.
6711
6712@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6713automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6714(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6715
6716@kindex tstatus
6717@cindex status of trace data collection
6718@cindex trace experiment, status of
6719@item tstatus
6720This command displays the status of the current trace data
6721collection.
6722@end table
6723
6724Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6725
6726@smallexample
6727(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6728(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6729Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6730> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6731> while-stepping 11
6732 > collect $regs
6733 > end
6734> end
6735(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6736 [time passes @dots{}]
6737(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6738@end smallexample
6739
6740
6741@node Analyze Collected Data
6742@section Using the collected data
6743
6744After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6745for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6746collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6747snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6748consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6749examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6750specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6751snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6752registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6753rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6754debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6755(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6756behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6757when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6758the buffer will fail.
6759
6760@menu
6761* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6762* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6763* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6764@end menu
6765
6766@node tfind
6767@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6768
6769@kindex tfind
6770@cindex select trace snapshot
6771@cindex find trace snapshot
6772The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6773@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6774counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6775snapshot is selected.
6776
6777Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6778
6779@table @code
6780@item tfind start
6781Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6782@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6783
6784@item tfind none
6785Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6786
6787@item tfind end
6788Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6789
6790@item tfind
6791No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6792
6793@item tfind -
6794Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6795retracing earlier steps.
6796
6797@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6798Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6799proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6800argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6801for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6802
6803@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6804Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6805program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6806snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6807snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6808
6809@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6810Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6811addresses.
6812
6813@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6814Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6815@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6816
6817@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6818Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6819the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6820that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6821trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6822next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6823@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6824stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6825@end table
6826
6827The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6828designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6829instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6830snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6831trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6832simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6833snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6834@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6835The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6836for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6837no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6838(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6839no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6840tracepoint as the current one.
6841
6842In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6843these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6844scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6845you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6846registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6847
6848@smallexample
6849(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6850(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6851> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6852 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6853> tfind
6854> end
6855
6856Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6857Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6858Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6859Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6860Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6861Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6862Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6863Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6864Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6865Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6866Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6867@end smallexample
6868
6869Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6870the buffer:
6871
6872@smallexample
6873(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6874(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6875> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6876> tfind line
6877> end
6878
6879Frame 0, X = 1
6880Frame 7, X = 2
6881Frame 13, X = 255
6882@end smallexample
6883
6884@node tdump
6885@subsection @code{tdump}
6886@kindex tdump
6887@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6888@cindex tracepoint data, display
6889
6890This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6891the current trace snapshot.
6892
6893@smallexample
6894(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6895(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6896Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6897> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6898> end
6899
6900(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6901
6902(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6903#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6904at gdb_test.c:444
6905444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6906
6907(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6908Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6909d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6910d1 0x18 24
6911d2 0x80 128
6912d3 0x33 51
6913d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6914d5 0x22 34
6915d6 0xe0 224
6916d7 0x380035 3670069
6917a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6918a1 0x3000668 50333288
6919a2 0x100 256
6920a3 0x322000 3284992
6921a4 0x3000698 50333336
6922a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6923fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6924sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6925ps 0x0 0
6926pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6927fpcontrol 0x0 0
6928fpstatus 0x0 0
6929fpiaddr 0x0 0
6930p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6931p1 = (void *) 0x11
6932p2 = (void *) 0x22
6933p3 = (void *) 0x33
6934p4 = (void *) 0x44
6935p5 = (void *) 0x55
6936p6 = (void *) 0x66
6937gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6938
6939(@value{GDBP})
6940@end smallexample
6941
6942@node save-tracepoints
6943@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6944@kindex save-tracepoints
6945@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6946
6947This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6948their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6949suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6950tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6951Files}).
6952
6953@node Tracepoint Variables
6954@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6955@cindex tracepoint variables
6956@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6957
6958@table @code
6959@vindex $trace_frame
6960@item (int) $trace_frame
6961The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6962snapshot is selected.
6963
6964@vindex $tracepoint
6965@item (int) $tracepoint
6966The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6967
6968@vindex $trace_line
6969@item (int) $trace_line
6970The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6971
6972@vindex $trace_file
6973@item (char []) $trace_file
6974The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6975
6976@vindex $trace_func
6977@item (char []) $trace_func
6978The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6979@end table
6980
6981Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6982use @code{output} instead.
6983
6984Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6985stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6986data.
6987
6988@smallexample
6989(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6990
6991(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6992> output $trace_file
6993> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6994> tfind
6995> end
6996@end smallexample
6997
df0cd8c5
JB
6998@node Overlays
6999@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7000@cindex overlays
7001
7002If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7003memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7004problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7005use overlays.
7006
7007@menu
7008* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7009* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7010* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7011 mapped by asking the inferior.
7012* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7013@end menu
7014
7015@node How Overlays Work
7016@section How Overlays Work
7017@cindex mapped overlays
7018@cindex unmapped overlays
7019@cindex load address, overlay's
7020@cindex mapped address
7021@cindex overlay area
7022
7023Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7024kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7025other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7026management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7027adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7028
7029One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7030independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7031@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7032their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7033instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7034largest overlay as well.
7035
7036Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7037overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7038for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7039there.
7040
c928edc0
AC
7041@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7042@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7043@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7044
474c8240 7045@smallexample
df0cd8c5 7046@group
c928edc0
AC
7047 Data Instruction Larger
7048Address Space Address Space Address Space
7049+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7050| | | | | |
7051+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7052| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7053| variables | | program | | +-----------+
7054| and heap | | | | | |
7055+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7056| | +-----------+ | | | load address
7057+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7058 | | | | | |
7059 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7060 address | | | | | |
7061 | overlay | <-' | | |
7062 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7063 | | <---. | | load address
7064 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7065 | | | |
7066 +-----------+ | |
7067 +-----------+
7068 | |
7069 +-----------+
7070
7071 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 7072@end group
474c8240 7073@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 7074
c928edc0
AC
7075The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7076and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7077its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7078Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7079may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7080data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7081program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7082program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
7083
7084An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7085@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7086instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7087in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7088is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7089the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7090called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7091
7092Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7093program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7094global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7095
7096@itemize @bullet
7097
7098@item
7099Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7100must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7101return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7102overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7103
7104@item
7105If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7106will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7107your program's performance.
7108
7109@item
7110The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7111overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7112mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7113and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7114You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7115addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7116ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7117
7118@item
7119The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7120to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7121instruction and data spaces.
7122
7123@end itemize
7124
7125The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7126improved in many ways:
7127
7128@itemize @bullet
7129
7130@item
7131If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7132hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7133contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7134This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7135area in the usual way.
7136
7137@item
7138If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7139overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7140
7141@item
7142You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7143general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7144code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7145return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7146the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7147must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7148different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7149
7150@end itemize
7151
7152
7153@node Overlay Commands
7154@section Overlay Commands
7155
7156To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7157correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7158virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7159mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7160@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7161variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7162
7163@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7164you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7165
7166@table @code
7167@item overlay off
7168@kindex overlay off
7169Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7170disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7171always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7172overlay support is disabled.
7173
7174@item overlay manual
7175@kindex overlay manual
7176@cindex manual overlay debugging
7177Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7178relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7179using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7180commands described below.
7181
7182@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7183@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7184@kindex overlay map-overlay
7185@cindex map an overlay
7186Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7187be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7188overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7189functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7190that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7191@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7192
7193@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7194@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7195@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7196@cindex unmap an overlay
7197Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7198must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7199When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7200overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7201
7202@item overlay auto
7203@kindex overlay auto
7204Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7205consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7206to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7207Overlay Debugging}.
7208
7209@item overlay load-target
7210@itemx overlay load
7211@kindex overlay load-target
7212@cindex reloading the overlay table
7213Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7214re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7215stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7216overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7217useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7218
7219@item overlay list-overlays
7220@itemx overlay list
7221@cindex listing mapped overlays
7222Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7223addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7224
7225@end table
7226
7227Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7228of the function the address falls in:
7229
474c8240 7230@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7231(gdb) print main
7232$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 7233@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7234@noindent
7235When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7236unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7237asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7238unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7239
474c8240 7240@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7241(gdb) overlay list
7242No sections are mapped.
7243(gdb) print foo
7244$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 7245@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7246@noindent
7247When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7248name normally:
7249
474c8240 7250@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7251(gdb) overlay list
7252Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7253 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7254(gdb) print foo
7255$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 7256@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7257
7258When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7259address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7260overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7261@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7262code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7263
7264@itemize @bullet
7265@item
7266@cindex breakpoints in overlays
7267@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7268You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7269@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7270@item
7271@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7272unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7273overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7274you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7275breakpoints properly.
7276@end itemize
7277
7278
7279@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7280@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7281@cindex automatic overlay debugging
7282
7283@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7284are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7285inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7286@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7287looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7288current state of the overlays.
7289
7290Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7291@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7292
7293@table @asis
7294
7295@item @code{_ovly_table}:
7296This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7297
474c8240 7298@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7299struct
7300@{
7301 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7302 unsigned long vma;
7303
7304 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7305 unsigned long size;
7306
7307 /* The overlay's load address. */
7308 unsigned long lma;
7309
7310 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7311 zero otherwise. */
7312 unsigned long mapped;
7313@}
474c8240 7314@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7315
7316@item @code{_novlys}:
7317This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7318number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7319
7320@end table
7321
7322To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7323looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7324@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7325executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7326the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7327currently mapped.
7328
81d46470 7329In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 7330@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
7331will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7332calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7333will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7334are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7335in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7336overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7337are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
7338
7339@node Overlay Sample Program
7340@section Overlay Sample Program
7341@cindex overlay example program
7342
7343When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7344at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7345addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7346Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7347since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7348architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7349portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7350
7351However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7352program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7353suite. The program consists of the following files from
7354@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7355
7356@table @file
7357@item overlays.c
7358The main program file.
7359@item ovlymgr.c
7360A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7361@item foo.c
7362@itemx bar.c
7363@itemx baz.c
7364@itemx grbx.c
7365Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7366@item d10v.ld
7367@itemx m32r.ld
7368Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7369and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7370@end table
7371
7372You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7373cross-compiler like this:
7374
474c8240 7375@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7376$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7377$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7378$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7379$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7380$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7381$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7382$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7383 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 7384@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7385
7386The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7387you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7388target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7389
7390
6d2ebf8b 7391@node Languages
c906108c
SS
7392@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7393@cindex languages
7394
c906108c
SS
7395Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7396rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7397dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7398Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 7399represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 7400@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
7401
7402@cindex working language
7403Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7404allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7405native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7406consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7407language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7408language}.
7409
7410@menu
7411* Setting:: Switching between source languages
7412* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 7413* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
7414* Support:: Supported languages
7415@end menu
7416
6d2ebf8b 7417@node Setting
c906108c
SS
7418@section Switching between source languages
7419
7420There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7421set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7422@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7423defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7424used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7425are printed, etc.
7426
7427In addition to the working language, every source file that
7428@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7429file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7430source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7431language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 7432controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 7433show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
7434set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7435set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7436Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
7437
7438This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 7439as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
7440another language. In that case, make the
7441program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7442@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7443program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7444
7445@menu
7446* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7447* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7448* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7449@end menu
7450
6d2ebf8b 7451@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
7452@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7453
7454If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7455@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7456
7457@table @file
7458
7459@item .c
7460C source file
7461
7462@item .C
7463@itemx .cc
7464@itemx .cp
7465@itemx .cpp
7466@itemx .cxx
7467@itemx .c++
b37052ae 7468C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
7469
7470@item .f
7471@itemx .F
7472Fortran source file
7473
c906108c
SS
7474@item .mod
7475Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
7476
7477@item .s
7478@itemx .S
7479Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7480@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7481@end table
7482
7483In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7484extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7485
6d2ebf8b 7486@node Manually
c906108c
SS
7487@subsection Setting the working language
7488
7489If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7490expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7491your program.
7492
7493@kindex set language
7494If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7495command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 7496a language, such as
c906108c 7497@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
7498For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7499
c906108c
SS
7500Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7501language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7502to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7503source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7504languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7505source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7506command such as:
7507
474c8240 7508@smallexample
c906108c 7509print a = b + c
474c8240 7510@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7511
7512@noindent
7513might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7514@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7515printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7516@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 7517
6d2ebf8b 7518@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
7519@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7520
7521To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7522@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7523then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7524frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7525working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7526frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7527or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7528does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7529not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7530
7531This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7532entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7533written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7534a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7535case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7536
6d2ebf8b 7537@node Show
c906108c 7538@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
7539
7540The following commands help you find out which language is the
7541working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7542
7543@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
7544@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7545@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
7546@table @code
7547@item show language
7548Display the current working language. This is the
7549language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7550build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7551
7552@item info frame
5d161b24 7553Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 7554working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 7555@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7556information listed here.
7557
7558@item info source
7559Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 7560@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7561information listed here.
7562@end table
7563
7564In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7565not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7566with a language explicitly:
7567
7568@kindex set extension-language
7569@kindex info extensions
7570@table @code
7571@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7572Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7573the source language @var{language}.
7574
7575@item info extensions
7576List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7577@end table
7578
6d2ebf8b 7579@node Checks
c906108c
SS
7580@section Type and range checking
7581
7582@quotation
7583@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7584checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7585section documents the intended facilities.
7586@end quotation
7587@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7588
7589Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7590errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7591checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7592sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7593these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7594by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7595errors when your program is running.
7596
7597@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7598Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7599can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7600the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7601@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7602your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7603for the default settings of supported languages.
7604
7605@menu
7606* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7607* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7608@end menu
7609
7610@cindex type checking
7611@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7612@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7613@subsection An overview of type checking
7614
7615Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7616arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7617otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7618errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7619
7620@smallexample
76211 + 2 @result{} 3
7622@exdent but
7623@error{} 1 + 2.3
7624@end smallexample
7625
7626The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7627type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7628
5d161b24
DB
7629For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7630@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7631to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7632or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7633but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7634these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7635also issues a warning.
7636
5d161b24
DB
7637Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7638related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7639For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7640a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7641with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7642the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7643
7644Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7645instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7646operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7647represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7648operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7649details on specific languages.
7650
7651@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7652
d4f3574e 7653@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7654@kindex set check type
7655@kindex show check type
7656@table @code
7657@item set check type auto
7658Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7659@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7660each language.
7661
7662@item set check type on
7663@itemx set check type off
7664Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7665current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7666match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7667evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7668message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7669
7670@item set check type warn
7671Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7672evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7673be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7674numbers and structures.
7675
7676@item show type
5d161b24 7677Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7678is setting it automatically.
7679@end table
7680
7681@cindex range checking
7682@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7683@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7684@subsection An overview of range checking
7685
7686In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7687bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7688checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7689computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7690not exceed the bounds of the array.
7691
7692For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7693@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7694always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7695warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7696
7697A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7698array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7699of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7700error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7701result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7702the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7703
474c8240 7704@smallexample
c906108c 7705@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7706@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7707
7708This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7709specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7710Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7711
7712@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7713
d4f3574e 7714@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7715@kindex set check range
7716@kindex show check range
7717@table @code
7718@item set check range auto
7719Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7720@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7721each language.
7722
7723@item set check range on
7724@itemx set check range off
7725Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7726current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7727match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7728then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7729
7730@item set check range warn
7731Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7732but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7733expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7734memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7735systems).
7736
7737@item show range
7738Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7739being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7740@end table
c906108c 7741
6d2ebf8b 7742@node Support
c906108c 7743@section Supported languages
c906108c 7744
e632838e 7745@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7746@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7747Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7748language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7749and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7750,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7751language.
7752
7753The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7754supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7755tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7756@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7757formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7758books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7759language reference or tutorial.
7760
c906108c 7761@menu
b37052ae 7762* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7763* Modula-2:: Modula-2
c906108c
SS
7764@end menu
7765
6d2ebf8b 7766@node C
b37052ae 7767@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7768
b37052ae
EZ
7769@cindex C and C@t{++}
7770@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7771
b37052ae 7772Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7773to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7774together.
7775
41afff9a
EZ
7776@cindex C@t{++}
7777@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7778@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7779The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7780compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7781effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7782C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7783compiler (@code{aCC}).
7784
b37052ae 7785For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
7786format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7787command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7788@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7789CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 7790
c906108c 7791@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7792* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7793* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7794* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7795* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7796* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7797* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7798* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7799@end menu
c906108c 7800
6d2ebf8b 7801@node C Operators
b37052ae 7802@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7803
b37052ae 7804@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7805
7806Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7807@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7808often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7809
b37052ae 7810For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7811
7812@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7813
c906108c 7814@item
c906108c 7815@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7816specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7817
7818@item
d4f3574e
SS
7819@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7820@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7821
7822@item
53a5351d 7823@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7824
7825@item
7826@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7827
c906108c
SS
7828@end itemize
7829
7830@noindent
7831The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7832in order of increasing precedence:
7833
7834@table @code
7835@item ,
7836The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7837are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7838expression being the last expression evaluated.
7839
7840@item =
7841Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7842assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7843
7844@item @var{op}=
7845Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7846and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7847@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7848@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7849@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7850
7851@item ?:
7852The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7853of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7854integral type.
7855
7856@item ||
7857Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7858
7859@item &&
7860Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7861
7862@item |
7863Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7864
7865@item ^
7866Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7867
7868@item &
7869Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7870
7871@item ==@r{, }!=
7872Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7873expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7874
7875@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7876Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7877Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7878and non-zero for true.
7879
7880@item <<@r{, }>>
7881left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7882
7883@item @@
7884The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7885
7886@item +@r{, }-
7887Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7888pointer types.
7889
7890@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7891Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7892defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7893integral types.
7894
7895@item ++@r{, }--
7896Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7897operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7898when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7899operation takes place.
7900
7901@item *
7902Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7903@code{++}.
7904
7905@item &
7906Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7907
b37052ae
EZ
7908For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7909allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7910(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7911where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7912stored.
c906108c
SS
7913
7914@item -
7915Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7916precedence as @code{++}.
7917
7918@item !
7919Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7920@code{++}.
7921
7922@item ~
7923Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7924@code{++}.
7925
7926
7927@item .@r{, }->
7928Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7929@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7930pointer based on the stored type information.
7931Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7932
c906108c
SS
7933@item .*@r{, }->*
7934Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7935
7936@item []
7937Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7938@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7939
7940@item ()
7941Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7942
c906108c 7943@item ::
b37052ae 7944C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7945and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7946
7947@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7948Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7949(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7950above.
c906108c
SS
7951@end table
7952
c906108c
SS
7953If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7954attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7955predefined meaning.
c906108c 7956
c906108c 7957@menu
5d161b24 7958* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7959@end menu
7960
6d2ebf8b 7961@node C Constants
b37052ae 7962@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7963
b37052ae 7964@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7965
b37052ae 7966@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7967following ways:
c906108c
SS
7968
7969@itemize @bullet
7970@item
7971Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
7972specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
7973by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
7974@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7975@code{long} value.
7976
7977@item
7978Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7979point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7980exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7981@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7982sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
7983A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7984@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7985the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7986a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7987constant.
c906108c
SS
7988
7989@item
7990Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7991integral equivalents.
7992
7993@item
7994Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7995(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 7996(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
7997be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
7998the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
7999of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8000@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8001@samp{\n} for newline.
8002
8003@item
96a2c332
SS
8004String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8005double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8006above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8007a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8008characters.
c906108c
SS
8009
8010@item
8011Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8012to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8013
8014@item
8015Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8016and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8017integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8018and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8019@end itemize
8020
c906108c 8021@menu
5d161b24
DB
8022* C plus plus expressions::
8023* C Defaults::
8024* C Checks::
c906108c 8025
5d161b24 8026* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
8027@end menu
8028
6d2ebf8b 8029@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
8030@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8031
8032@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8033@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8034
8035@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
8036@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
8037@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
8038@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
8039@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
8040@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
8041@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
8042@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
8043@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8044@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
8045@c periodically whether this has happened...
8046@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
8047@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8048proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
8049additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
8050special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
8051@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
8052symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
8053you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
8054extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 8055@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8056support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
8057@end quotation
c906108c
SS
8058
8059@enumerate
8060
8061@cindex member functions
8062@item
8063Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8064
474c8240 8065@smallexample
c906108c 8066count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 8067@end smallexample
c906108c 8068
41afff9a 8069@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 8070@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8071@item
8072While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8073expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8074that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 8075pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 8076
c906108c 8077@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 8078@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 8079@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8080@item
8081You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 8082call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
8083perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8084calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8085in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8086default arguments.
8087
8088It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8089promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8090class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8091functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8092number of function arguments.
8093
8094Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8095@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 8096,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 8097
d4f3574e 8098You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
8099explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8100@smallexample
8101p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8102@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8103
c906108c 8104The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 8105see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 8106
c906108c
SS
8107@cindex reference declarations
8108@item
b37052ae
EZ
8109@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8110them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
8111dereferenced.
8112
8113In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8114reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8115avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8116The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8117you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8118
8119@item
b37052ae 8120@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
8121expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8122one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8123necessary, for example in an expression like
8124@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 8125resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8126debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8127@end enumerate
8128
b37052ae 8129In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
8130calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8131objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8132invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 8133
6d2ebf8b 8134@node C Defaults
b37052ae 8135@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 8136
b37052ae 8137@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 8138
c906108c
SS
8139If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8140both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 8141C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8142selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
8143
8144If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8145recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8146@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 8147these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
8148@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8149for further details.
8150
c906108c
SS
8151@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8152@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8153@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 8154
6d2ebf8b 8155@node C Checks
b37052ae 8156@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 8157
b37052ae 8158@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 8159
b37052ae 8160By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
8161is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8162considers two variables type equivalent if:
8163
8164@itemize @bullet
8165@item
8166The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8167enumerated tag.
8168
8169@item
8170The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8171declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8172
8173@ignore
8174@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8175@c FIXME--beers?
8176@item
8177The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8178declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8179compilers.)
8180@end ignore
8181@end itemize
8182
8183Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8184indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8185that is not itself an array.
c906108c 8186
6d2ebf8b 8187@node Debugging C
c906108c 8188@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
8189
8190The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8191the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
8192inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8193appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
8194
8195The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8196with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8197,Expressions}.
8198
c906108c 8199@menu
5d161b24 8200* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
8201@end menu
8202
6d2ebf8b 8203@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 8204@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 8205
b37052ae 8206@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 8207
b37052ae
EZ
8208Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8209designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
8210
8211@table @code
8212@cindex break in overloaded functions
8213@item @r{breakpoint menus}
8214When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8215@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8216you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8217
b37052ae 8218@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8219@item rbreak @var{regex}
8220Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8221breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8222classes.
8223@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8224
b37052ae 8225@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
8226@item catch throw
8227@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 8228Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
8229Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8230
8231@cindex inheritance
8232@item ptype @var{typename}
8233Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8234@var{typename}.
8235@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8236
b37052ae 8237@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
8238@item set print demangle
8239@itemx show print demangle
8240@itemx set print asm-demangle
8241@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
8242Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8243displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
8244@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8245
8246@item set print object
8247@itemx show print object
8248Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8249@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8250
8251@item set print vtbl
8252@itemx show print vtbl
8253Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8254@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 8255(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 8256ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
8257
8258@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 8259@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 8260@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 8261Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
8262is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8263and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 8264using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 8265expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
8266message.
8267
8268@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 8269Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
8270overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8271chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8272symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8273overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8274searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8275argument types.
c906108c
SS
8276
8277@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8278You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 8279the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
8280@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8281also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8282available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8283@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8284@end table
c906108c 8285
6d2ebf8b 8286@node Modula-2
c906108c 8287@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 8288
d4f3574e 8289@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
8290
8291The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8292output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8293developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8294attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8295to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8296table.
8297
8298@cindex expressions in Modula-2
8299@menu
8300* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8301* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8302* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8303* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8304* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8305* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8306* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8307* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8308@end menu
8309
6d2ebf8b 8310@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
8311@subsubsection Operators
8312@cindex Modula-2 operators
8313
8314Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8315@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8316often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8317following definitions hold:
8318
8319@itemize @bullet
8320
8321@item
8322@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8323their subranges.
8324
8325@item
8326@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8327
8328@item
8329@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8330
8331@item
8332@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8333@var{type}}.
8334
8335@item
8336@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8337
8338@item
8339@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8340
8341@item
8342@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8343@end itemize
8344
8345@noindent
8346The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8347increasing precedence:
8348
8349@table @code
8350@item ,
8351Function argument or array index separator.
8352
8353@item :=
8354Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8355@var{value}.
8356
8357@item <@r{, }>
8358Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8359types.
8360
8361@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 8362Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
8363on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8364set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8365
8366@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8367Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8368Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8369available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8370comment character.
8371
8372@item IN
8373Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8374Same precedence as @code{<}.
8375
8376@item OR
8377Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8378
8379@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 8380Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
8381
8382@item @@
8383The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8384
8385@item +@r{, }-
8386Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8387and difference on set types.
8388
8389@item *
8390Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8391on set types.
8392
8393@item /
8394Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8395types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8396
8397@item DIV@r{, }MOD
8398Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8399precedence as @code{*}.
8400
8401@item -
8402Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8403
8404@item ^
8405Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8406
8407@item NOT
8408Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8409@code{^}.
8410
8411@item .
8412@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8413precedence as @code{^}.
8414
8415@item []
8416Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8417
8418@item ()
8419Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8420as @code{^}.
8421
8422@item ::@r{, }.
8423@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8424@end table
8425
8426@quotation
8427@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8428treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8429@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8430@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8431@end quotation
8432
cb51c4e0 8433
6d2ebf8b 8434@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 8435@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 8436@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
8437
8438Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8439In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8440
8441@table @var
8442
8443@item a
8444represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8445
8446@item c
8447represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8448
8449@item i
8450represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8451
8452@item m
8453represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8454same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8455be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8456
8457@item n
8458represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8459
8460@item r
8461represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8462
8463@item t
8464represents a type.
8465
8466@item v
8467represents a variable.
8468
8469@item x
8470represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8471explanation of the function for details.
8472@end table
8473
8474All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8475
8476@table @code
8477@item ABS(@var{n})
8478Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8479
8480@item CAP(@var{c})
8481If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 8482equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
8483
8484@item CHR(@var{i})
8485Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8486
8487@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8488Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8489
8490@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8491Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8492new value.
8493
8494@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8495Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8496set.
8497
8498@item FLOAT(@var{i})
8499Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8500
8501@item HIGH(@var{a})
8502Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8503
8504@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8505Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8506
8507@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8508Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8509new value.
8510
8511@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8512Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8513there. Returns the new set.
8514
8515@item MAX(@var{t})
8516Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8517
8518@item MIN(@var{t})
8519Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8520
8521@item ODD(@var{i})
8522Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8523
8524@item ORD(@var{x})
8525Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
8526value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8527@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
8528integral, character and enumerated types.
8529
8530@item SIZE(@var{x})
8531Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8532
8533@item TRUNC(@var{r})
8534Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8535
8536@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8537Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8538@end table
8539
8540@quotation
8541@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8542@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8543an error.
8544@end quotation
8545
8546@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 8547@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
8548@subsubsection Constants
8549
8550@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8551ways:
8552
8553@itemize @bullet
8554
8555@item
8556Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8557expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8558rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8559trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8560
8561@item
8562Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8563decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8564then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8565@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8566digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8567digits.
8568
8569@item
8570Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8571like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 8572also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
8573followed by a @samp{C}.
8574
8575@item
8576String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8577pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8578Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 8579Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
8580sequences.
8581
8582@item
8583Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8584
8585@item
8586Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8587@code{FALSE}.
8588
8589@item
8590Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8591
8592@item
8593Set constants are not yet supported.
8594@end itemize
8595
6d2ebf8b 8596@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8597@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8598@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8599
8600If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8601both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8602Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8603selected the working language.
8604
8605If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8606code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8607working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8608the language automatically}, for further details.
8609
6d2ebf8b 8610@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8611@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8612@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8613
8614A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8615This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8616
8617@itemize @bullet
8618@item
8619Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8620integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8621debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8622pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8623through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8624returned a pointer.)
8625
8626@item
8627C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8628non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8629escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8630printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8631
8632@item
8633The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8634argument.
8635
8636@item
8637All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8638@end itemize
8639
6d2ebf8b 8640@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8641@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8642@cindex Modula-2 checks
8643
8644@quotation
8645@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8646range checking.
8647@end quotation
8648@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8649
8650@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8651
8652@itemize @bullet
8653@item
8654They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8655@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8656
8657@item
8658They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8659@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8660@end itemize
8661
8662As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8663whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8664
8665Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8666index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8667
6d2ebf8b 8668@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8669@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8670@cindex scope
41afff9a 8671@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8672@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8673@ifinfo
41afff9a 8674@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8675@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8676@end ifinfo
8677@iftex
41afff9a 8678@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8679@end iftex
8680
8681There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8682(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8683similar syntax:
8684
474c8240 8685@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8686
8687@var{module} . @var{id}
8688@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 8689@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8690
8691@noindent
8692where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8693@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8694identifier within your program, except another module.
8695
8696Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8697specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8698found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8699enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8700
8701Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8702the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8703definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8704an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8705module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8706@var{module}.
8707
6d2ebf8b 8708@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8709@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8710
8711Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8712Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8713specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8714@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8715apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8716analogue in Modula-2.
8717
8718The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8719with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8720intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8721created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8722address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8723@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8724
8725@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8726In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8727interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8728
6d2ebf8b 8729@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8730@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8731
d4f3574e 8732The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8733symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8734program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8735does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8736program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8737(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8738file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8739
8740@cindex symbol names
8741@cindex names of symbols
8742@cindex quoting names
8743Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8744characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8745most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8746source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8747are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8748ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8749@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8750@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8751
474c8240 8752@smallexample
c906108c 8753p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 8754@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8755
8756@noindent
8757looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8758
8759@table @code
8760@kindex info address
b37052ae 8761@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8762@item info address @var{symbol}
8763Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8764variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8765local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8766is always stored.
8767
8768Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8769at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8770the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8771
3d67e040 8772@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8773@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8774@item info symbol @var{addr}
8775Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8776If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8777nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8778
474c8240 8779@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8780(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8781_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 8782@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8783
8784@noindent
8785This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8786it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8787
c906108c 8788@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8789@item whatis @var{expr}
8790Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8791actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8792assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8793@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8794
8795@item whatis
8796Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8797
8798@kindex ptype
8799@item ptype @var{typename}
8800Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8801the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8802@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8803@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8804
d4f3574e 8805@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8806@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8807Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8808differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8809of just the name of the type.
8810
8811For example, for this variable declaration:
8812
474c8240 8813@smallexample
c906108c 8814struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 8815@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8816
8817@noindent
8818the two commands give this output:
8819
474c8240 8820@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8821@group
8822(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8823type = struct complex
8824(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8825type = struct complex @{
8826 double real;
8827 double imag;
8828@}
8829@end group
474c8240 8830@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8831
8832@noindent
8833As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8834the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8835
8836@kindex info types
8837@item info types @var{regexp}
8838@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8839Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8840(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8841complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8842@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8843names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8844information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8845
8846This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8847@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8848lists all source files where a type is defined.
8849
b37052ae
EZ
8850@kindex info scope
8851@cindex local variables
8852@item info scope @var{addr}
8853List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8854accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8855preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8856scope defined by that location. For example:
8857
8858@smallexample
8859(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8860Scope for command_line_handler:
8861Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8862Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8863Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8864Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8865Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8866Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8867Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8868@end smallexample
8869
f5c37c66
EZ
8870@noindent
8871This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8872during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8873collect}.
8874
c906108c
SS
8875@kindex info source
8876@item info source
919d772c
JB
8877Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
8878the function containing the current point of execution:
8879@itemize @bullet
8880@item
8881the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
8882@item
8883the directory it was compiled in,
8884@item
8885its length, in lines,
8886@item
8887which programming language it is written in,
8888@item
8889whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
8890if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
8891@item
8892whether the debugging information includes information about
8893preprocessor macros.
8894@end itemize
8895
c906108c
SS
8896
8897@kindex info sources
8898@item info sources
8899Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8900debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8901have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8902
8903@kindex info functions
8904@item info functions
8905Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8906
8907@item info functions @var{regexp}
8908Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8909whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8910Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8911include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8912start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8913that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8914@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8915
8916@kindex info variables
8917@item info variables
8918Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 8919outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
8920
8921@item info variables @var{regexp}
8922Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8923variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8924@var{regexp}.
8925
8926@ignore
8927This was never implemented.
8928@kindex info methods
8929@item info methods
8930@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8931The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8932methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8933specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8934C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8935from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8936@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8937which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8938@end ignore
8939
c906108c
SS
8940@cindex reloading symbols
8941Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8942be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8943in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8944running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8945@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8946
8947@table @code
8948@kindex set symbol-reloading
8949@item set symbol-reloading on
8950Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8951object file with a particular name is seen again.
8952
8953@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8954Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8955same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8956running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8957should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8958may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8959several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8960name.
c906108c
SS
8961
8962@kindex show symbol-reloading
8963@item show symbol-reloading
8964Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8965@end table
c906108c 8966
c906108c
SS
8967@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8968@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8969Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8970declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8971@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8972source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8973another source file. The default is on.
8974
8975A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8976the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8977
8978@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8979Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8980is printed as follows:
8981@smallexample
8982@{<no data fields>@}
8983@end smallexample
8984
8985@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8986@item show opaque-type-resolution
8987Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8988
8989@kindex maint print symbols
8990@cindex symbol dump
8991@kindex maint print psymbols
8992@cindex partial symbol dump
8993@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8994@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8995@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8996Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8997These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8998symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8999symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9000collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9001only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9002command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9003use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9004symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9005files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9006@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9007required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9008@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9009@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9010@end table
9011
6d2ebf8b 9012@node Altering
c906108c
SS
9013@chapter Altering Execution
9014
9015Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9016find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9017correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9018experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9019program.
9020
9021For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
9022locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9023address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
9024
9025@menu
9026* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9027* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 9028* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
9029* Returning:: Returning from a function
9030* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9031* Patching:: Patching your program
9032@end menu
9033
6d2ebf8b 9034@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
9035@section Assignment to variables
9036
9037@cindex assignment
9038@cindex setting variables
9039To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9040@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9041
474c8240 9042@smallexample
c906108c 9043print x=4
474c8240 9044@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9045
9046@noindent
9047stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 9048value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
9049@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9050information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
9051
9052@kindex set variable
9053@cindex variables, setting
9054If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9055@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9056really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9057not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9058,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9059
c906108c
SS
9060If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9061appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9062variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9063to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9064program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9065a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9066command @code{set width}:
9067
474c8240 9068@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9069(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9070type = double
9071(@value{GDBP}) p width
9072$4 = 13
9073(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9074Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 9075@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9076
9077@noindent
9078The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9079order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9080
474c8240 9081@smallexample
c906108c 9082(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 9083@end smallexample
53a5351d 9084
c906108c
SS
9085Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9086with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9087@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9088your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9089to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9090the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9091
474c8240 9092@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9093@group
9094(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9095type = double
9096(@value{GDBP}) p g
9097$1 = 1
9098(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 9099(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
9100$2 = 1
9101(@value{GDBP}) r
9102The program being debugged has been started already.
9103Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9104Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
9105"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9106 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
9107(@value{GDBP}) show g
9108The current BFD target is "=4".
9109@end group
474c8240 9110@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9111
9112@noindent
9113The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9114@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9115@code{g}, use
9116
474c8240 9117@smallexample
c906108c 9118(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9119@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9120
9121@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9122freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9123and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9124same length or shorter.
9125@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9126@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9127
9128To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9129construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9130(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9131to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9132and representation in memory), and
9133
474c8240 9134@smallexample
c906108c 9135set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9136@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9137
9138@noindent
9139stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9140
6d2ebf8b 9141@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9142@section Continuing at a different address
9143
9144Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9145it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9146an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9147
9148@table @code
9149@kindex jump
9150@item jump @var{linespec}
9151Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9152immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9153source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9154@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9155in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9156breakpoints}.
9157
9158The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9159the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9160register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9161a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9162be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9163of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9164confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9165executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9166well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9167
9168@item jump *@var{address}
9169Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9170@end table
9171
c906108c 9172@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9173On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9174command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9175difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9176changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9177example,
c906108c 9178
474c8240 9179@smallexample
c906108c 9180set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9181@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9182
9183@noindent
9184makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9185address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9186@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9187
9188The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9189up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9190that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9191detail.
9192
c906108c 9193@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9194@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9195@section Giving your program a signal
9196
9197@table @code
9198@kindex signal
9199@item signal @var{signal}
9200Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9201signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9202signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9203SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9204
9205Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9206giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9207a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9208@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9209signal.
9210
9211@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9212after executing the command.
9213@end table
9214@c @end group
9215
9216Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9217@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9218causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9219the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9220passes the signal directly to your program.
9221
c906108c 9222
6d2ebf8b 9223@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9224@section Returning from a function
9225
9226@table @code
9227@cindex returning from a function
9228@kindex return
9229@item return
9230@itemx return @var{expression}
9231You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9232command. If you give an
9233@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9234value.
9235@end table
9236
9237When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9238(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9239discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9240be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9241
9242This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9243frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9244innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9245specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9246of functions.
9247
9248The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9249program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9250returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9251and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9252selected stack frame returns naturally.
9253
6d2ebf8b 9254@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9255@section Calling program functions
9256
9257@cindex calling functions
9258@kindex call
9259@table @code
9260@item call @var{expr}
9261Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9262returned values.
9263@end table
9264
9265You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9266execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9267with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9268is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9269
6d2ebf8b 9270@node Patching
c906108c 9271@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9272
c906108c
SS
9273@cindex patching binaries
9274@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9275@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9276
7a292a7a
SS
9277By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9278executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9279alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9280patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9281
9282If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9283explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9284want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9285repairs.
9286
9287@table @code
9288@kindex set write
9289@item set write on
9290@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9291If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9292core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9293off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9294
9295If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9296@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9297write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9298
9299@item show write
9300@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9301Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9302as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9303@end table
9304
6d2ebf8b 9305@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9306@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9307
7a292a7a
SS
9308@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9309both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9310program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9311@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9312
9313@menu
9314* Files:: Commands to specify files
9315* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9316@end menu
9317
6d2ebf8b 9318@node Files
c906108c 9319@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9320
7a292a7a 9321@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9322@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9323
9324You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9325way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9326@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9327Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9328
9329Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9330@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9331a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9332to specify new files are useful.
9333
9334@table @code
9335@cindex executable file
9336@kindex file
9337@item file @var{filename}
9338Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9339symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9340executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9341directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9342@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9343directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9344to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9345and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9346
6d2ebf8b 9347On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9348@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9349@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9350@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9351descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9352(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9353@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9354for more information.
c906108c
SS
9355
9356@item file
9357@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9358has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9359
9360@kindex exec-file
9361@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9362Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9363in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9364if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9365discard information on the executable file.
9366
9367@kindex symbol-file
9368@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9369Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9370searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9371table and program to run from the same file.
9372
9373@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9374program's symbol table.
9375
5d161b24 9376The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9377of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9378auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9379the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9380the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9381
9382@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9383executing it once.
9384
9385When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9386understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9387generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9388other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9389Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9390using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9391optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9392
9393For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9394using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9395symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9396quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9397details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9398
9399The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9400start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9401occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9402file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9403pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9404warnings and messages}.)
9405
c906108c
SS
9406We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9407symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9408symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9409still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9410in stabs format.
9411
9412@kindex readnow
9413@cindex reading symbols immediately
9414@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9415@kindex mapped
9416@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9417@cindex saving symbol table
9418@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9419@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9420You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9421tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9422load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9423entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9424
c906108c
SS
9425If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9426@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9427cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9428file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9429from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9430than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9431program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9432starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9433
9434You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9435file has all the symbol information for your program.
9436
9437The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9438@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9439than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9440it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9441needed.
9442
9443The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9444@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9445symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9446
9447@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9448@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9449@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9450@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9451@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9452@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9453@c files.
9454
9455@kindex core
9456@kindex core-file
9457@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9458Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9459of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9460address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9461executable file itself for other parts.
9462
9463@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9464to be used.
9465
9466Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9467under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9468wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9469the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9470(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9471
c906108c
SS
9472@kindex add-symbol-file
9473@cindex dynamic linking
9474@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9475@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9476@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9477The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9478information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9479when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9480into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9481address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9482this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9483of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9484section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9485@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9486
9487The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9488originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9489@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9490thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9491instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9492
17d9d558
JB
9493@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9494@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9495@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9496@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9497@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9498Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9499executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9500relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9501information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9502
9503@itemize @bullet
9504@item
9505the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9506that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9507@item
9508every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9509been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9510@item
9511you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9512provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9513@end itemize
9514
9515@noindent
9516Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9517relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9518typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9519important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9520procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9521assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9522general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9523relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9524as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9525way.
9526
c906108c
SS
9527@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9528
9529You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9530the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9531table information for @var{filename}.
9532
9533@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9534@item add-shared-symbol-file
9535The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9536operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9537shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9538@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9539
c906108c
SS
9540@kindex section
9541@item section
5d161b24
DB
9542The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9543the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9544section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9545specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9546separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9547the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9548
9549@kindex info files
9550@kindex info target
9551@item info files
9552@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9553@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9554current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9555including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9556use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9557command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9558current ones.
9559
fe95c787
MS
9560@kindex maint info sections
9561@item maint info sections
9562Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9563is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9564displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9565offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9566@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9567may be arbitrarily combined):
9568
9569@table @code
9570@item ALLOBJ
9571Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9572@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9573Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9574@item @var{section-flags}
9575Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9576The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9577@table @code
9578@item ALLOC
9579Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9580Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9581@item LOAD
9582Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9583Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9584@item RELOC
9585Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9586@item READONLY
9587Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9588@item CODE
9589Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9590@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9591Section contains data only (no executable code).
9592@item ROM
9593Section will reside in ROM.
9594@item CONSTRUCTOR
9595Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9596@item HAS_CONTENTS
9597Section is not empty.
9598@item NEVER_LOAD
9599An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9600@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9601A notification to the linker that the section contains
9602COFF shared library information.
9603@item IS_COMMON
9604Section contains common symbols.
9605@end table
9606@end table
6763aef9
MS
9607@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9608@item set trust-readonly-sections on
9609Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 9610really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
9611In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9612out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9613For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9614enhancement to debugging performance.
9615
9616The default is off.
9617
9618@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 9619Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
9620the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9621and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
9622@end table
9623
9624All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9625as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9626name and remembers it that way.
9627
c906108c 9628@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9629@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9630libraries.
53a5351d 9631
c906108c
SS
9632@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9633when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9634(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9635references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9636debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9637
9638On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9639automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9640
c906108c
SS
9641@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9642@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9643@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9644
b7209cb4
FF
9645There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9646symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9647particularly large or there are many of them.
9648
9649To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9650commands:
9651
9652@table @code
9653@kindex set auto-solib-add
9654@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9655If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9656will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9657attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9658informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9659is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9660@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9661
9662@kindex show auto-solib-add
9663@item show auto-solib-add
9664Display the current autoloading mode.
9665@end table
9666
9667To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9668command:
9669
c906108c
SS
9670@table @code
9671@kindex info sharedlibrary
9672@kindex info share
9673@item info share
9674@itemx info sharedlibrary
9675Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9676
9677@kindex sharedlibrary
9678@kindex share
9679@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9680@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9681Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9682Unix regular expression.
9683As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9684required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9685@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9686loaded.
9687@end table
9688
b7209cb4
FF
9689On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9690autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9691reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9692by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9693up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9694wish.
c906108c
SS
9695
9696Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9697loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9698@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9699automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9700
9701To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9702
9703@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9704@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9705@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9706Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9707If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9708symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9709size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9710Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 9711@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 9712Mb).
c906108c 9713
b7209cb4
FF
9714@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9715@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9716Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9717@end table
c906108c 9718
6d2ebf8b 9719@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9720@section Errors reading symbol files
9721
9722While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9723such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9724output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9725they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9726debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9727about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9728only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9729times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9730to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9731complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9732messages}).
9733
9734The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9735
9736@table @code
9737@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9738
9739The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9740(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9741error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9742in its outer scope blocks.
9743
9744@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9745the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9746may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9747function.
9748
9749@item block at @var{address} out of order
9750
9751The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9752order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9753do so.
9754
9755@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9756locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9757can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9758@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9759messages}.)
9760
9761@item bad block start address patched
9762
9763The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9764smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9765to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9766
9767@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9768starting on the previous source line.
9769
9770@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9771
9772@cindex foo
9773Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9774larger than the size of the string table.
9775
9776@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9777name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9778with this name.
9779
9780@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9781
7a292a7a
SS
9782The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9783not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9784uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9785
7a292a7a
SS
9786@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9787This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9788are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9789debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9790on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9791and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9792
9793@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9794
7a292a7a 9795@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9796
7a292a7a 9797@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9798The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9799information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9800it.
c906108c
SS
9801
9802@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9803
9804@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9805
c906108c
SS
9806@end table
9807
6d2ebf8b 9808@node Targets
c906108c 9809@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9810
c906108c
SS
9811@cindex debugging target
9812@kindex target
9813
9814A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9815
9816Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9817in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9818you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9819flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9820host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9821realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9822command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9823(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9824
9825@menu
9826* Active Targets:: Active targets
9827* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9828* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9829* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9830* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9831
9832@end menu
9833
6d2ebf8b 9834@node Active Targets
c906108c 9835@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9836
c906108c
SS
9837@cindex stacking targets
9838@cindex active targets
9839@cindex multiple targets
9840
c906108c 9841There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9842executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9843active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9844start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9845a core file.
c906108c
SS
9846
9847For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9848@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9849well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9850@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9851first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9852requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9853are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9854read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9855executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9856
9857When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9858target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9859commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9860an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9861process target is active.
c906108c 9862
7a292a7a
SS
9863Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9864core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9865files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9866the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9867process}).
c906108c 9868
6d2ebf8b 9869@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9870@section Commands for managing targets
9871
9872@table @code
9873@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9874Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9875process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9876facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9877protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9878
9879Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9880typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9881with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9882
9883The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9884after executing the command.
9885
9886@kindex help target
9887@item help target
9888Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9889currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9890(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9891
9892@item help target @var{name}
9893Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9894select it.
9895
9896@kindex set gnutarget
9897@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9898@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9899knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9900a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9901with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9902with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9903
d4f3574e 9904@quotation
c906108c
SS
9905@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9906you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9907@end quotation
c906108c 9908
d4f3574e
SS
9909@noindent
9910@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9911
5d161b24 9912@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9913@item show gnutarget
9914Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9915@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9916@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9917and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9918@end table
9919
c906108c
SS
9920Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9921configuration):
c906108c
SS
9922
9923@table @code
9924@kindex target exec
9925@item target exec @var{program}
9926An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9927@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9928
c906108c
SS
9929@kindex target core
9930@item target core @var{filename}
9931A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9932@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9933
9934@kindex target remote
9935@item target remote @var{dev}
9936Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9937specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9938@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9939supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9940some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9941it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9942
c906108c
SS
9943@kindex target sim
9944@item target sim
2df3850c 9945Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 9946In general,
474c8240 9947@smallexample
104c1213
JM
9948 target sim
9949 load
9950 run
474c8240 9951@end smallexample
d4f3574e 9952@noindent
104c1213 9953works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9954drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9955provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9956see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9957Processors}.
9958
c906108c
SS
9959@end table
9960
104c1213 9961Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9962
9963@table @code
9964
c906108c
SS
9965@kindex target nrom
9966@item target nrom @var{dev}
9967NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9968
c906108c
SS
9969@end table
9970
5d161b24 9971Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9972your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9973
9974Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9975once you've successfully established a connection.
9976
9977@table @code
9978
9979@kindex load @var{filename}
9980@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9981Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9982@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9983is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9984on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9985@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9986the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9987
9988If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9989execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9990target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9991
9992The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9993For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9994link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9995specifies a fixed address.
9996@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9997
c906108c
SS
9998@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9999@end table
10000
6d2ebf8b 10001@node Byte Order
c906108c 10002@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 10003
c906108c
SS
10004@cindex choosing target byte order
10005@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
10006
10007Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10008offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10009orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10010designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10011which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 10012@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
10013
10014@table @code
10015@kindex set endian big
10016@item set endian big
10017Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10018
10019@kindex set endian little
10020@item set endian little
10021Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10022
10023@kindex set endian auto
10024@item set endian auto
10025Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10026executable.
10027
10028@item show endian
10029Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10030
10031@end table
10032
10033Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10034data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10035target system.
10036
6d2ebf8b 10037@node Remote
c906108c
SS
10038@section Remote debugging
10039@cindex remote debugging
10040
10041If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
10042@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10043For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
10044or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10045powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10046
10047Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10048to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 10049@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
10050but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10051write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10052communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10053
10054Other remote targets may be available in your
10055configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 10056
6f05cf9f
AC
10057@node KOD
10058@section Kernel Object Display
10059
10060@cindex kernel object display
10061@cindex kernel object
10062@cindex KOD
10063
10064Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10065@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10066and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10067mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10068displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10069
10070Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10071@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10072
474c8240 10073@smallexample
6f05cf9f 10074(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 10075@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10076
10077If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10078about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10079which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10080after the operating system:
c906108c 10081
474c8240 10082@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10083(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10084List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10085Object Description
10086any Any and all objects
474c8240 10087@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10088
10089Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10090by the kernel.
10091
10092There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10093is supported other than to try it.
10094
10095
10096@node Remote Debugging
10097@chapter Debugging remote programs
10098
6b2f586d
AC
10099@menu
10100* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10101* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10102* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
10103@end menu
10104
6f05cf9f
AC
10105@node Server
10106@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10107
10108@kindex gdbserver
10109@cindex remote connection without stubs
10110@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10111allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10112@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10113
10114@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10115because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10116that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10117@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10118@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10119because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10120also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10121started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10122Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10123the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10124do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10125by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10126choice for debugging.
10127
10128@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10129or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10130protocol.
10131
10132@table @emph
10133@item On the target machine,
10134you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10135@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10136strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10137system does all the symbol handling.
10138
10139To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10140the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10141syntax is:
10142
10143@smallexample
10144target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10145@end smallexample
10146
10147@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10148hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10149@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10150@file{/dev/com1}:
10151
10152@smallexample
10153target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10154@end smallexample
10155
10156@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10157with it.
10158
10159To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10160
10161@smallexample
10162target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10163@end smallexample
10164
10165The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10166specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10167TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10168expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10169(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10170you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10171TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10172reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10173conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10174and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10175@code{target remote} command.
10176
56460a61
DJ
10177On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10178This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10179
10180@smallexample
10181target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10182@end smallexample
10183
10184@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10185to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10186
6f05cf9f
AC
10187@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10188you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10189symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10190using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10191(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10192running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10193remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10194is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10195@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10196@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10197
10198@smallexample
10199(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10200@end smallexample
10201
10202@noindent
10203communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10204
10205@smallexample
10206(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10207@end smallexample
10208
10209@noindent
10210communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10211For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10212the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10213text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10214@samp{Connection refused}.
10215@end table
10216
10217@node NetWare
10218@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10219
10220@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10221@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10222allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10223@code{target remote}.
10224
10225@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10226using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10227
10228@table @emph
10229@item On the target machine,
10230you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10231@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10232can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10233host system does all the symbol handling.
10234
10235To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10236@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10237program. The syntax is:
10238
10239@smallexample
10240load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10241 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10242@end smallexample
10243
10244@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10245the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10246to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10247
10248For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10249communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10250using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10251
10252@smallexample
10253load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10254@end smallexample
10255
10256@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10257you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10258symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10259using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10260(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10261running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10262remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10263argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10264@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10265
10266@smallexample
10267(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10268@end smallexample
10269
10270@noindent
10271communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10272@end table
10273
10274@node remote stub
10275@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10276
8e04817f
AC
10277@cindex debugging stub, example
10278@cindex remote stub, example
10279@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10280The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10281communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10282@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10283these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10284implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10285with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10286organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10287
104c1213
JM
10288@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10289To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10290@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10291prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10292program, you need:
c906108c 10293
104c1213
JM
10294@enumerate
10295@item
10296A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10297have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10298your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10299
5d161b24 10300@item
d4f3574e 10301A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10302subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10303
104c1213
JM
10304@item
10305A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10306download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10307manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10308documentation.
10309@end enumerate
96baa820 10310
104c1213
JM
10311The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10312communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10313machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10314
104c1213
JM
10315@table @emph
10316@item On the host,
10317@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10318else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10319(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10320
10321@item On the target,
10322you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10323implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10324subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10325
10326On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10327@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10328@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10329@end table
96baa820 10330
104c1213
JM
10331The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10332machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10333@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10334
104c1213
JM
10335@cindex remote serial stub list
10336These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10337
104c1213
JM
10338@table @code
10339
10340@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10341@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10342@cindex Intel
10343@cindex i386
10344For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10345
10346@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10347@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10348@cindex Motorola 680x0
10349@cindex m680x0
10350For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10351
10352@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10353@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10354@cindex Hitachi
10355@cindex SH
10356For Hitachi SH architectures.
10357
10358@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10359@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10360@cindex Sparc
10361For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10362
10363@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10364@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10365@cindex Fujitsu
10366@cindex SparcLite
10367For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10368
10369@end table
10370
10371The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10372recently added stubs.
10373
10374@menu
10375* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10376* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10377* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10378@end menu
10379
6d2ebf8b 10380@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10381@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10382
10383@cindex remote serial stub
10384The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10385subroutines:
10386
10387@table @code
10388@item set_debug_traps
10389@kindex set_debug_traps
10390@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10391This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10392program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10393beginning of your program.
10394
10395@item handle_exception
10396@kindex handle_exception
10397@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10398This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10399explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10400run when a trap is triggered.
10401
10402@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10403execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10404with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10405protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10406representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10407information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10408retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10409execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10410@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10411machine.
104c1213
JM
10412
10413@item breakpoint
10414@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10415Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10416breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10417way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10418machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10419pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10420@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10421simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10422again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10423your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10424@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10425
10426Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10427to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10428start of your debugging session.
10429@end table
10430
6d2ebf8b 10431@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10432@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10433
10434@cindex remote stub, support routines
10435The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10436chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10437debugging target machine.
10438
10439First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10440serial port.
10441
10442@table @code
10443@item int getDebugChar()
10444@kindex getDebugChar
10445Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10446It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10447different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10448
10449@item void putDebugChar(int)
10450@kindex putDebugChar
10451Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10452It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10453different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10454@end table
10455
10456@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10457@cindex interrupting remote targets
10458If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10459running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10460for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10461character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10462remote system to stop.
10463
10464Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10465probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10466is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10467@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10468
10469Other routines you need to supply are:
10470
10471@table @code
10472@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10473@kindex exceptionHandler
10474Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10475handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10476way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10477are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10478containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10479@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10480its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10481might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10482exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10483@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10484and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10485you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10486should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10487
10488For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10489gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10490should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10491@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10492help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10493
10494@item void flush_i_cache()
10495@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10496On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10497instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10498instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10499
10500On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10501function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10502@end table
10503
10504@noindent
10505You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10506
10507@table @code
10508@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10509@kindex memset
10510This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10511memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10512@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10513either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10514@end table
10515
10516If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10517library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10518but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10519subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10520
10521
6d2ebf8b 10522@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 10523@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10524
10525@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10526In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10527steps.
10528
10529@enumerate
10530@item
6d2ebf8b 10531Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10532(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10533@display
10534@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10535@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10536@end display
10537
10538@item
10539Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10540
474c8240 10541@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10542set_debug_traps();
10543breakpoint();
474c8240 10544@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10545
10546@item
10547For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10548@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10549
474c8240 10550@smallexample
104c1213 10551void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 10552@end smallexample
104c1213 10553
d4f3574e 10554@noindent
104c1213 10555but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10556function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10557@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10558error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10559one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10560
10561@item
10562Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10563your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10564
10565@item
10566Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10567the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10568
10569@item
10570@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10571@c document that. FIXME.
10572Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10573whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10574
10575@item
10576To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10577as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10578This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10579of its pure text.
10580
d4f3574e 10581@item
104c1213 10582@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10583Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10584Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10585machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9db8d71f 10586TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
104c1213
JM
10587to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10588device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10589
474c8240 10590@smallexample
104c1213 10591target remote /dev/ttyb
474c8240 10592@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10593
10594@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10595To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9db8d71f
DJ
10596@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10597For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
104c1213
JM
10598terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10599
474c8240 10600@smallexample
104c1213 10601target remote manyfarms:2828
474c8240 10602@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10603
10604If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10605your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10606the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10607to port 1234 on your local machine:
10608
474c8240 10609@smallexample
a2bea4c3 10610target remote :1234
474c8240 10611@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10612@noindent
10613
10614Note that the colon is still required here.
9db8d71f
DJ
10615
10616@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10617To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10618@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10619on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10620
10621@smallexample
10622target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10623@end smallexample
10624
10625When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10626that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10627busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10628session.
10629
104c1213
JM
10630@end enumerate
10631
10632Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10633step and continue the remote program.
10634
10635To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10636command.
10637
10638@cindex interrupting remote programs
10639@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10640Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10641interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10642program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10643and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10644interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10645
474c8240 10646@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10647Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10648Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
474c8240 10649@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10650
10651If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10652(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10653remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10654goes back to waiting.
10655
104c1213 10656
8e04817f
AC
10657@node Configurations
10658@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 10659
8e04817f
AC
10660While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10661cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10662describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 10663
8e04817f
AC
10664There are three major categories of configurations: native
10665configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10666operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10667different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10668are quite different from each other.
104c1213 10669
8e04817f
AC
10670@menu
10671* Native::
10672* Embedded OS::
10673* Embedded Processors::
10674* Architectures::
10675@end menu
104c1213 10676
8e04817f
AC
10677@node Native
10678@section Native
104c1213 10679
8e04817f
AC
10680This section describes details specific to particular native
10681configurations.
6cf7e474 10682
8e04817f
AC
10683@menu
10684* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10685* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10686* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 10687* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 10688@end menu
6cf7e474 10689
8e04817f
AC
10690@node HP-UX
10691@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 10692
8e04817f
AC
10693On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10694begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10695name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 10696
8e04817f
AC
10697@node SVR4 Process Information
10698@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 10699
8e04817f
AC
10700@kindex /proc
10701@cindex process image
104c1213 10702
8e04817f
AC
10703Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10704used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10705subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10706this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10707several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10708@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10709@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
1104b9e7 10710and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
104c1213 10711
8e04817f
AC
10712@table @code
10713@kindex info proc
10714@item info proc
10715Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 10716
8e04817f
AC
10717@kindex info proc mappings
10718@item info proc mappings
10719Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10720on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10721@ignore
10722@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10723@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10724@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10725@kindex info proc times
10726@item info proc times
10727Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10728its children.
6cf7e474 10729
8e04817f
AC
10730@kindex info proc id
10731@item info proc id
10732Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10733the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 10734
8e04817f
AC
10735@kindex info proc status
10736@item info proc status
10737General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10738stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10739received.
d4f3574e 10740
8e04817f
AC
10741@item info proc all
10742Show all the above information about the process.
10743@end ignore
10744@end table
104c1213 10745
8e04817f
AC
10746@node DJGPP Native
10747@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10748@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10749@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10750@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 10751
8e04817f
AC
10752@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10753MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10754that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10755top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 10756
8e04817f
AC
10757@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10758defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10759subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 10760
8e04817f
AC
10761@table @code
10762@kindex info dos
10763@item info dos
10764This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10765information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 10766
8e04817f
AC
10767@kindex sysinfo
10768@cindex MS-DOS system info
10769@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10770@item info dos sysinfo
10771This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10772platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10773DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 10774
8e04817f
AC
10775@cindex GDT
10776@cindex LDT
10777@cindex IDT
10778@cindex segment descriptor tables
10779@cindex descriptor tables display
10780@item info dos gdt
10781@itemx info dos ldt
10782@itemx info dos idt
10783These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10784and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10785tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10786that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10787descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10788descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10789rights.
104c1213 10790
8e04817f
AC
10791A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10792segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10793allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10794conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10795additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 10796
8e04817f
AC
10797@cindex garbled pointers
10798These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10799Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10800displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10801display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10802example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10803debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 10804
8e04817f
AC
10805@smallexample
10806@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
10807@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
10808@end smallexample
104c1213 10809
8e04817f
AC
10810@noindent
10811This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10812the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 10813
8e04817f
AC
10814@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10815@item info dos pde
10816@itemx info dos pte
10817These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10818Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10819data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10820into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10821page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10822may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10823Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10824that is currently in use.
104c1213 10825
8e04817f
AC
10826Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10827Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10828the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10829@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10830Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10831means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10832the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 10833
8e04817f
AC
10834@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
10835These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10836Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10837controller.
104c1213 10838
8e04817f 10839These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 10840
8e04817f
AC
10841@cindex physical address from linear address
10842@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
10843This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10844address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
10845appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10846accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10847example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
10848the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 10849
8e04817f
AC
10850@smallexample
10851@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
10852@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
10853@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
10854@end smallexample
104c1213 10855
8e04817f
AC
10856@noindent
10857This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
10858whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
10859attributes of that page.
104c1213 10860
8e04817f
AC
10861Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
10862since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
10863address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
10864be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
10865declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
10866@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 10867
8e04817f
AC
10868Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
10869transfer buffer:
104c1213 10870
8e04817f
AC
10871@smallexample
10872@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
10873@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
10874@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
10875@end smallexample
104c1213 10876
8e04817f
AC
10877@noindent
10878(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
108793rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
10880this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
10881mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 10882
8e04817f
AC
10883This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
10884@end table
104c1213 10885
78c47bea
PM
10886@node Cygwin Native
10887@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
10888@cindex MS Windows debugging
10889@cindex native Cygwin debugging
10890@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
10891
10892@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
10893defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
10894subsection describes those commands.
10895
10896@table @code
10897@kindex info w32
10898@item info w32
10899This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
10900information about the target system and important OS structures.
10901
10902@item info w32 selector
10903This command displays information returned by
10904the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
10905It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
10906a long value to give the information about this given selector.
10907Without argument, this command displays information
10908about the the six segment registers.
10909
10910@kindex info dll
10911@item info dll
10912This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
10913
10914@kindex dll-symbols
10915@item dll-symbols
10916This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
10917add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
10918
10919@kindex set new-console
10920@item set new-console @var{mode}
10921If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
10922be started in a new console on next start.
10923If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
10924be started in the same console as the debugger.
10925
10926@kindex show new-console
10927@item show new-console
10928Displays whether a new console is used
10929when the debuggee is started.
10930
10931@kindex set new-group
10932@item set new-group @var{mode}
10933This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
10934start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
10935This affects the way the Windows OS handles
10936Ctrl-C.
10937
10938@kindex show new-group
10939@item show new-group
10940Displays current value of new-group boolean.
10941
10942@kindex set debugevents
10943@item set debugevents
10944This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
10945
10946@kindex set debugexec
10947@item set debugexec
10948This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
10949seen by the debugger.
10950
10951@kindex set debugexceptions
10952@item set debugexceptions
10953This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
10954seen by the debugger.
10955
10956@kindex set debugmemory
10957@item set debugmemory
10958This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
10959seen by the debugger.
10960
10961@kindex set shell
10962@item set shell
10963This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
10964via a shell or directly (default value is on).
10965
10966@kindex show shell
10967@item show shell
10968Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
10969
10970@end table
10971
8e04817f
AC
10972@node Embedded OS
10973@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 10974
8e04817f
AC
10975This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10976embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10977architectures.
d4f3574e 10978
8e04817f
AC
10979@menu
10980* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10981@end menu
104c1213 10982
8e04817f
AC
10983@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10984various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 10985
8e04817f
AC
10986@node VxWorks
10987@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 10988
8e04817f 10989@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 10990
8e04817f 10991@table @code
104c1213 10992
8e04817f
AC
10993@kindex target vxworks
10994@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10995A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10996is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 10997
8e04817f 10998@end table
104c1213 10999
8e04817f
AC
11000On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11001current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 11002
8e04817f
AC
11003@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11004VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11005the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11006both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11007@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11008installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11009@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 11010
8e04817f
AC
11011@table @code
11012@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11013@kindex vxworks-timeout
11014All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11015This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11016seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11017your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11018of a thin network line.
11019@end table
104c1213 11020
8e04817f
AC
11021The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11022this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11023procedures.
104c1213 11024
8e04817f
AC
11025@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11026To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11027to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11028library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11029VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11030kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11031source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11032information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11033manual.
11034@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 11035
8e04817f
AC
11036Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11037your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11038run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11039@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11040
8e04817f 11041@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 11042
474c8240 11043@smallexample
8e04817f 11044(vxgdb)
474c8240 11045@end smallexample
104c1213 11046
8e04817f
AC
11047@menu
11048* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11049* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11050* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11051@end menu
104c1213 11052
8e04817f
AC
11053@node VxWorks Connection
11054@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 11055
8e04817f
AC
11056The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11057network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 11058
474c8240 11059@smallexample
8e04817f 11060(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 11061@end smallexample
104c1213 11062
8e04817f
AC
11063@need 750
11064@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11065
8e04817f
AC
11066@smallexample
11067Attaching remote machine across net...
11068Connected to tt.
11069@end smallexample
104c1213 11070
8e04817f
AC
11071@need 1000
11072@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11073loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11074these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11075path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11076to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 11077
474c8240 11078@smallexample
8e04817f 11079prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11080@end smallexample
104c1213 11081
8e04817f
AC
11082When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11083the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11084command again.
104c1213 11085
8e04817f
AC
11086@node VxWorks Download
11087@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 11088
8e04817f
AC
11089@cindex download to VxWorks
11090If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11091object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11092@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11093incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11094command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11095to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11096table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11097the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11098filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11099Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11100to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11101the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11102@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11103and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11104program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 11105
474c8240 11106@smallexample
8e04817f 11107-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11108@end smallexample
104c1213 11109
8e04817f
AC
11110@noindent
11111Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11112
474c8240 11113@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11114(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11115(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11116@end smallexample
104c1213 11117
8e04817f 11118@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11119
8e04817f
AC
11120@smallexample
11121Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11122@end smallexample
104c1213 11123
8e04817f
AC
11124You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11125after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11126this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11127auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11128history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11129debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11130table.)
104c1213 11131
8e04817f
AC
11132@node VxWorks Attach
11133@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11134
11135@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11136You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11137follows:
11138
474c8240 11139@smallexample
104c1213 11140(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11141@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11142
11143@noindent
11144where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11145or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11146the time of attachment.
11147
6d2ebf8b 11148@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11149@section Embedded Processors
11150
11151This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11152configurations.
11153
7d86b5d5 11154
104c1213 11155@menu
104c1213
JM
11156* ARM:: ARM
11157* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11158* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11159* i960:: Intel i960
11160* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11161* M68K:: Motorola M68K
104c1213 11162* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
a37295f9 11163* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
104c1213
JM
11164* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11165* PowerPC: PowerPC
11166* SH:: Hitachi SH
11167* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11168* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11169* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11170* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11171@end menu
11172
6d2ebf8b 11173@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11174@subsection ARM
11175
11176@table @code
11177
8e04817f
AC
11178@kindex target rdi
11179@item target rdi @var{dev}
11180ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11181use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11182monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11183
11184@kindex target rdp
11185@item target rdp @var{dev}
11186ARM Demon monitor.
11187
11188@end table
11189
11190@node H8/300
11191@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11192
11193@table @code
11194
11195@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11196@item target hms @var{dev}
11197A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11198Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11199line and the communications speed used.
11200
11201@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11202@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11203E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11204
11205@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11206@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11207@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11208@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11209Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11210
11211@end table
11212
11213@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11214@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11215@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11216@cindex Hitachi SH download
11217When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11218board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11219board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11220@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11221
11222@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11223Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11224
11225@enumerate
11226@item
11227that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11228for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11229emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11230the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11231H8/300, or H8/500.)
11232
11233@item
11234what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11235serial device available on your host is the default).
11236
11237@item
11238what speed to use over the serial device.
11239@end enumerate
11240
11241@menu
11242* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11243* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11244* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11245@end menu
11246
11247@node Hitachi Boards
11248@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11249
11250@c only for Unix hosts
11251@kindex device
11252@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11253Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11254need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11255first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11256hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11257
11258@kindex speed
11259@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11260@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11261speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11262hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11263the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11264@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11265
11266The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11267use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11268use a DOS host,
11269@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11270called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11271through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11272to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11273
11274The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11275program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11276sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11277the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11278
11279First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11280board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11281port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11282When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11283debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11284for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11285@code{COM2}.
11286
474c8240 11287@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11288C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11289C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11290
11291Resident portion of MODE loaded
11292
11293COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11294
474c8240 11295@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11296
11297@quotation
11298@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11299@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11300disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11301your development board.
11302@end quotation
11303
11304@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11305Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11306connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11307the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11308you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11309commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11310cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11311download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11312the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11313(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11314executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11315@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11316itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11317
11318@smallexample
11319(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11320@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11321 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11322 the conditions.
11323There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11324for details.
11325@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11326(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11327Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11328(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11329.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11330.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11331.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11332@end smallexample
11333
11334At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11335you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11336sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11337@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11338resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11339@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11340
11341Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11342available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11343you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11344
11345Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11346@itemize @bullet
11347@item
11348to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11349no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11350
11351@item
11352to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11353normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11354to detect program completion.
11355@end itemize
11356
11357In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11358development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11359
11360@node Hitachi ICE
11361@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11362
11363@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11364You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11365Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11366e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11367
11368@table @code
11369@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11370Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11371@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11372@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11373(for example, @samp{9600}).
11374
11375@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11376If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11377specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11378@end table
11379
11380@node Hitachi Special
11381@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11382
11383Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11384
11385@table @code
11386
11387@kindex set machine
11388@kindex show machine
11389@item set machine h8300
11390@itemx set machine h8300h
11391Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11392architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11393to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11394
11395@end table
11396
8e04817f
AC
11397@node H8/500
11398@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11399
11400@table @code
11401
8e04817f
AC
11402@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11403@cindex memory models, H8/500
11404@item set memory @var{mod}
11405@itemx show memory
11406Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11407@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11408memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11409@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11410
8e04817f 11411@end table
104c1213 11412
8e04817f
AC
11413@node i960
11414@subsection Intel i960
104c1213 11415
8e04817f 11416@table @code
104c1213 11417
8e04817f
AC
11418@kindex target mon960
11419@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11420MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
104c1213 11421
8e04817f
AC
11422@kindex target nindy
11423@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11424An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11425the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11426@file{/dev/ttya}.
104c1213 11427
8e04817f
AC
11428@end table
11429
11430@cindex Nindy
11431@cindex i960
11432@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11433@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11434tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11435
11436@itemize @bullet
104c1213 11437@item
8e04817f
AC
11438Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11439Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
104c1213
JM
11440
11441@item
8e04817f 11442By responding to a prompt on startup;
104c1213
JM
11443
11444@item
8e04817f
AC
11445By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11446session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11447
11448@end itemize
11449
11450@cindex download to Nindy-960
11451With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11452downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11453@value{GDBN}.
11454
11455@menu
11456* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11457* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11458* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11459@end menu
11460
11461@node Nindy Startup
11462@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11463
11464If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11465options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11466reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11467
474c8240 11468@smallexample
8e04817f 11469Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
474c8240 11470@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11471
11472@noindent
11473Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11474identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11475simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11476with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11477use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11478
11479@node Nindy Options
11480@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11481
11482These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11483Nindy-960 board attached:
11484
11485@table @code
11486@item -r @var{port}
11487Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11488to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11489configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11490@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11491device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11492suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11493
11494@item -O
11495(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11496the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11497This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11498target architecture.
11499
11500@quotation
11501@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11502connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11503fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11504attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11505this process with an interrupt.
11506@end quotation
11507
11508@item -brk
11509Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11510system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11511
11512@quotation
11513@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11514requires; it only works with a few boards.
11515@end quotation
11516@end table
11517
11518The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11519port.
11520
11521@c @group
11522@node Nindy Reset
11523@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11524
11525@table @code
11526@item reset
11527@kindex reset
11528For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11529system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11530circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11531a break is detected.
11532@end table
11533@c @end group
11534
11535@node M32R/D
11536@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11537
11538@table @code
11539
11540@kindex target m32r
11541@item target m32r @var{dev}
11542Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11543
11544@end table
11545
11546@node M68K
11547@subsection M68k
11548
11549The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11550target command for the following ROM monitors.
11551
11552@table @code
11553
11554@kindex target abug
11555@item target abug @var{dev}
11556ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11557
11558@kindex target cpu32bug
11559@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11560CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11561
11562@kindex target dbug
11563@item target dbug @var{dev}
11564dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11565
11566@kindex target est
11567@item target est @var{dev}
11568EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11569
11570@kindex target rom68k
11571@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11572ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11573
11574@end table
11575
11576If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11577instead have only a single special target command:
11578
11579@table @code
11580
11581@kindex target es1800
11582@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11583ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11584
11585@end table
11586
11587[context?]
11588
11589@table @code
11590
11591@kindex target rombug
11592@item target rombug @var{dev}
11593ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11594
11595@end table
11596
8e04817f
AC
11597@node MIPS Embedded
11598@subsection MIPS Embedded
11599
11600@cindex MIPS boards
11601@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11602MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11603you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 11604
8e04817f
AC
11605@need 1000
11606Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 11607
8e04817f
AC
11608@table @code
11609@item target mips @var{port}
11610@kindex target mips @var{port}
11611To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11612name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11613command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11614the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11615been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11616download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 11617
8e04817f
AC
11618For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11619port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11620debugger:
104c1213 11621
474c8240 11622@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11623host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11624@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11625(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11626(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11627(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 11628@end smallexample
104c1213 11629
8e04817f
AC
11630@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11631On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11632connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11633concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11634@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11635
8e04817f
AC
11636@item target pmon @var{port}
11637@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11638PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 11639
8e04817f
AC
11640@item target ddb @var{port}
11641@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11642NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 11643
8e04817f
AC
11644@item target lsi @var{port}
11645@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11646LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 11647
8e04817f
AC
11648@kindex target r3900
11649@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11650Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 11651
8e04817f
AC
11652@kindex target array
11653@item target array @var{dev}
11654Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 11655
8e04817f 11656@end table
104c1213 11657
104c1213 11658
8e04817f
AC
11659@noindent
11660@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 11661
8e04817f
AC
11662@table @code
11663@item set processor @var{args}
11664@itemx show processor
11665@kindex set processor @var{args}
11666@kindex show processor
11667Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11668processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11669For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11670to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11671Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11672is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11673@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 11674
8e04817f
AC
11675@item set mipsfpu double
11676@itemx set mipsfpu single
11677@itemx set mipsfpu none
11678@itemx show mipsfpu
11679@kindex set mipsfpu
11680@kindex show mipsfpu
11681@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11682@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11683If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11684coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11685need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11686file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11687functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11688@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11689functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11690with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11691processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11692double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11693@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 11694
8e04817f
AC
11695In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11696floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11697and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 11698
8e04817f
AC
11699As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11700@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 11701
8e04817f
AC
11702@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11703@itemx show remotedebug
11704@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11705@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11706@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11707@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11708@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11709@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11710You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11711by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11712@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11713to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11714at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 11715
8e04817f
AC
11716@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11717@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11718@itemx show timeout
11719@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11720@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11721@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11722@kindex set timeout
11723@kindex show timeout
11724@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11725@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11726You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11727remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11728default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11729waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11730retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11731You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11732retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11733@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 11734
8e04817f
AC
11735The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11736is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11737forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11738to run before stopping.
11739@end table
104c1213 11740
a37295f9
MM
11741@node OpenRISC 1000
11742@subsection OpenRISC 1000
11743@cindex OpenRISC 1000
11744
11745@cindex or1k boards
11746See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
11747about platform and commands.
11748
11749@table @code
11750
11751@kindex target jtag
11752@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
11753
11754Connects to remote JTAG server.
11755JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
11756connected via parallel port to the board.
11757
11758Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
11759
11760@kindex or1ksim
11761@item or1ksim @var{command}
11762If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
11763Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
11764
11765@kindex info or1k spr
11766@item info or1k spr
11767Displays spr groups.
11768
11769@item info or1k spr @var{group}
11770@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
11771Displays register names in selected group.
11772
11773@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
11774@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
11775@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
11776@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
11777Shows information about specified spr register.
11778
11779@kindex spr
11780@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
11781@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
11782@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
11783@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
11784Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
11785@end table
11786
11787Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
11788It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
11789program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
11790triggers can be set using:
11791@table @code
11792@item $LEA/$LDATA
11793Load effective address/data
11794@item $SEA/$SDATA
11795Store effective address/data
11796@item $AEA/$ADATA
11797Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
11798@item $FETCH
11799Fetch data
11800@end table
11801
11802When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
11803@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
11804
11805@code{htrace} commands:
11806@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
11807@table @code
11808@kindex hwatch
11809@item hwatch @var{conditional}
11810Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
11811or Data. For example:
11812
11813@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11814
11815@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11816
11817@kindex htrace info
11818@item htrace info
11819Display information about current HW trace configuration.
11820
11821@kindex htrace trigger
11822@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
11823Set starting criteria for HW trace.
11824
11825@kindex htrace qualifier
11826@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
11827Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
11828
11829@kindex htrace stop
11830@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
11831Set HW trace stopping criteria.
11832
11833@kindex htrace record
11834@item htrace record @var{[data]*}
11835Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
11836triggered.
11837
11838@kindex htrace enable
11839@item htrace enable
11840@kindex htrace disable
11841@itemx htrace disable
11842Enables/disables the HW trace.
11843
11844@kindex htrace rewind
11845@item htrace rewind @var{[filename]}
11846Clears currently recorded trace data.
11847
11848If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
11849will be written there.
11850
11851@kindex htrace print
11852@item htrace print @var{[start [len]]}
11853Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
11854
11855@kindex htrace mode continuous
11856@item htrace mode continuous
11857Set continuous trace mode.
11858
11859@kindex htrace mode suspend
11860@item htrace mode suspend
11861Set suspend trace mode.
11862
11863@end table
11864
8e04817f
AC
11865@node PowerPC
11866@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11867
11868@table @code
104c1213 11869
8e04817f
AC
11870@kindex target dink32
11871@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11872DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 11873
8e04817f
AC
11874@kindex target ppcbug
11875@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11876@kindex target ppcbug1
11877@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11878PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 11879
8e04817f
AC
11880@kindex target sds
11881@item target sds @var{dev}
11882SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11883
11884@end table
11885
11886@node PA
11887@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
11888
11889@table @code
11890
8e04817f
AC
11891@kindex target op50n
11892@item target op50n @var{dev}
11893OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11894
11895@kindex target w89k
11896@item target w89k @var{dev}
11897W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
11898
11899@end table
11900
8e04817f
AC
11901@node SH
11902@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
11903
11904@table @code
11905
8e04817f
AC
11906@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11907@item target hms @var{dev}
11908A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11909commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11910the communications speed used.
104c1213 11911
8e04817f
AC
11912@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11913@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11914E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 11915
8e04817f
AC
11916@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11917@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11918@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11919@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11920Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 11921
8e04817f 11922@end table
104c1213 11923
8e04817f
AC
11924@node Sparclet
11925@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 11926
8e04817f
AC
11927@cindex Sparclet
11928
11929@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11930Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11931@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11932both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
11933@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 11934
8e04817f
AC
11935@table @code
11936@item remotetimeout @var{args}
11937@kindex remotetimeout
11938@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11939This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11940seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11941@end table
11942
8e04817f
AC
11943@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11944When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11945information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11946load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11947@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 11948
474c8240 11949@smallexample
8e04817f 11950sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 11951@end smallexample
104c1213 11952
8e04817f 11953You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 11954
474c8240 11955@smallexample
8e04817f 11956sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 11957@end smallexample
104c1213 11958
8e04817f
AC
11959@cindex running, on Sparclet
11960Once you have set
11961your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11962run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11963(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11964
8e04817f
AC
11965@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11966
474c8240 11967@smallexample
8e04817f 11968(gdbslet)
474c8240 11969@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11970
11971@menu
8e04817f
AC
11972* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11973* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11974* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
11975* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11976@end menu
11977
8e04817f
AC
11978@node Sparclet File
11979@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 11980
8e04817f 11981The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 11982
474c8240 11983@smallexample
8e04817f 11984(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 11985@end smallexample
104c1213 11986
8e04817f
AC
11987@need 1000
11988@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11989@value{GDBN} locates
11990the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11991path.
11992If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11993files will be searched as well.
11994@value{GDBN} locates
11995the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11996path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11997If it fails
11998to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 11999
474c8240 12000@smallexample
8e04817f 12001prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 12002@end smallexample
104c1213 12003
8e04817f
AC
12004When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12005the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12006@code{target} command again.
104c1213 12007
8e04817f
AC
12008@node Sparclet Connection
12009@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 12010
8e04817f
AC
12011The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12012To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 12013
474c8240 12014@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12015(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12016Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12017main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 12018@end smallexample
104c1213 12019
8e04817f
AC
12020@need 750
12021@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 12022
474c8240 12023@smallexample
8e04817f 12024Connected to ttya.
474c8240 12025@end smallexample
104c1213 12026
8e04817f
AC
12027@node Sparclet Download
12028@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 12029
8e04817f
AC
12030@cindex download to Sparclet
12031Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12032you can use the @value{GDBN}
12033@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12034The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12035command.
12036Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12037address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12038offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12039of each of the file's sections.
12040For instance, if the program
12041@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12042and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 12043
474c8240 12044@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12045(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12046Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 12047@end smallexample
104c1213 12048
8e04817f
AC
12049If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12050to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12051to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12052
12053@node Sparclet Execution
12054@subsubsection Running and debugging
12055
12056@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12057You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12058commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12059manual for the list of commands.
12060
474c8240 12061@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12062(gdbslet) b main
12063Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12064(gdbslet) run
12065Starting program: prog
12066Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
120673 char *symarg = 0;
12068(gdbslet) step
120694 char *execarg = "hello!";
12070(gdbslet)
474c8240 12071@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12072
12073@node Sparclite
12074@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12075
12076@table @code
12077
8e04817f
AC
12078@kindex target sparclite
12079@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12080Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12081You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12082For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12083remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
12084
12085@end table
12086
8e04817f
AC
12087@node ST2000
12088@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 12089
8e04817f
AC
12090@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12091STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 12092
8e04817f
AC
12093To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12094manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 12095
474c8240 12096@smallexample
8e04817f 12097target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 12098@end smallexample
104c1213 12099
8e04817f
AC
12100@noindent
12101to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12102the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12103ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12104connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12105concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12106
8e04817f
AC
12107The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12108this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12109would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12110(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12111available on your host computer.
12112@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12113@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 12114
8e04817f
AC
12115@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12116These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12117environment:
104c1213 12118
8e04817f
AC
12119@table @code
12120@item st2000 @var{command}
12121@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12122@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12123@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12124Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12125manual for available commands.
104c1213 12126
8e04817f
AC
12127@item connect
12128@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12129Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12130you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12131sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12132@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12133@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
12134@end table
12135
8e04817f
AC
12136@node Z8000
12137@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 12138
8e04817f
AC
12139@cindex Z8000
12140@cindex simulator, Z8000
12141@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 12142
8e04817f
AC
12143When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12144a Z8000 simulator.
12145
12146For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12147unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12148segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12149appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 12150
8e04817f
AC
12151@table @code
12152@item target sim @var{args}
12153@kindex sim
12154@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12155Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12156options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
12157@end table
12158
8e04817f
AC
12159@noindent
12160After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12161CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12162@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12163to run your program, and so on.
12164
12165As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12166(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12167additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12168
12169@table @code
12170
8e04817f
AC
12171@item cycles
12172Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 12173
8e04817f
AC
12174@item insts
12175Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12176
8e04817f
AC
12177@item time
12178Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12179
8e04817f 12180@end table
104c1213 12181
8e04817f
AC
12182You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12183conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12184conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12185simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12186
8e04817f
AC
12187@node Architectures
12188@section Architectures
104c1213 12189
8e04817f
AC
12190This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12191all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12192
8e04817f
AC
12193@menu
12194* A29K::
12195* Alpha::
12196* MIPS::
12197@end menu
104c1213 12198
8e04817f
AC
12199@node A29K
12200@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12201
12202@table @code
104c1213 12203
8e04817f
AC
12204@kindex set rstack_high_address
12205@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12206@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12207@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12208On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12209@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12210extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12211stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12212memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12213this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12214the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12215address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12216hexadecimal.
104c1213 12217
8e04817f
AC
12218@kindex show rstack_high_address
12219@item show rstack_high_address
12220Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12221processors.
104c1213 12222
8e04817f 12223@end table
104c1213 12224
8e04817f
AC
12225@node Alpha
12226@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12227
8e04817f 12228See the following section.
104c1213 12229
8e04817f
AC
12230@node MIPS
12231@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12232
8e04817f
AC
12233@cindex stack on Alpha
12234@cindex stack on MIPS
12235@cindex Alpha stack
12236@cindex MIPS stack
12237Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12238sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12239find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12240
8e04817f
AC
12241@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12242To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12243@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12244you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12245commands:
104c1213 12246
8e04817f
AC
12247@table @code
12248@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12249@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12250Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12251search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12252default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12253larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12254and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12255
8e04817f
AC
12256@item show heuristic-fence-post
12257Display the current limit.
12258@end table
104c1213
JM
12259
12260@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12261These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12262for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12263
104c1213 12264
8e04817f
AC
12265@node Controlling GDB
12266@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12267
12268You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12269@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12270data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12271described here.
12272
12273@menu
12274* Prompt:: Prompt
12275* Editing:: Command editing
12276* History:: Command history
12277* Screen Size:: Screen size
12278* Numbers:: Numbers
1e698235 12279* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
8e04817f
AC
12280* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12281* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12282@end menu
12283
12284@node Prompt
12285@section Prompt
104c1213 12286
8e04817f 12287@cindex prompt
104c1213 12288
8e04817f
AC
12289@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12290called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12291can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12292instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12293the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12294which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12295
8e04817f
AC
12296@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12297prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12298or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12299
8e04817f
AC
12300@table @code
12301@kindex set prompt
12302@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12303Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12304
8e04817f
AC
12305@kindex show prompt
12306@item show prompt
12307Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12308@end table
12309
8e04817f
AC
12310@node Editing
12311@section Command editing
12312@cindex readline
12313@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12314
8e04817f
AC
12315@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12316@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12317command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12318or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12319substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12320debugging sessions.
104c1213 12321
8e04817f
AC
12322You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12323command @code{set}.
104c1213 12324
8e04817f
AC
12325@table @code
12326@kindex set editing
12327@cindex editing
12328@item set editing
12329@itemx set editing on
12330Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12331
8e04817f
AC
12332@item set editing off
12333Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12334
8e04817f
AC
12335@kindex show editing
12336@item show editing
12337Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12338@end table
12339
8e04817f
AC
12340@node History
12341@section Command history
12342
12343@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12344debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12345happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12346history facility.
104c1213
JM
12347
12348@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12349@cindex history substitution
12350@cindex history file
12351@kindex set history filename
12352@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12353@item set history filename @var{fname}
12354Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12355This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12356list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12357exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12358the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12359to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12360@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12361is not set.
104c1213 12362
8e04817f
AC
12363@cindex history save
12364@kindex set history save
12365@item set history save
12366@itemx set history save on
12367Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12368@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12369
8e04817f
AC
12370@item set history save off
12371Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12372
8e04817f
AC
12373@cindex history size
12374@kindex set history size
12375@item set history size @var{size}
12376Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12377This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12378@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12379@end table
12380
8e04817f
AC
12381@cindex history expansion
12382History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12383@ifset have-readline-appendices
12384@xref{Event Designators}.
12385@end ifset
12386
12387Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12388is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12389@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12390follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12391a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12392history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12393@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12394
12395The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12396
12397@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12398@kindex set history expansion
12399@item set history expansion on
12400@itemx set history expansion
12401Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12402
8e04817f
AC
12403@item set history expansion off
12404Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12405
8e04817f
AC
12406The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12407editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12408or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12409@ifset have-readline-appendices
12410@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12411@end ifset
104c1213 12412
8e04817f
AC
12413@c @group
12414@kindex show history
12415@item show history
12416@itemx show history filename
12417@itemx show history save
12418@itemx show history size
12419@itemx show history expansion
12420These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12421@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12422@c @end group
12423@end table
12424
12425@table @code
12426@kindex shows
12427@item show commands
12428Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12429
8e04817f
AC
12430@item show commands @var{n}
12431Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12432
12433@item show commands +
12434Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12435@end table
12436
8e04817f
AC
12437@node Screen Size
12438@section Screen size
12439@cindex size of screen
12440@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12441
8e04817f
AC
12442Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12443information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12444@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12445output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12446to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12447determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12448printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12449rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12450
12451Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12452driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12453together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12454@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12455you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12456width} commands:
12457
12458@table @code
12459@kindex set height
12460@kindex set width
12461@kindex show width
12462@kindex show height
12463@item set height @var{lpp}
12464@itemx show height
12465@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12466@itemx show width
12467These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12468a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12469commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12470
8e04817f
AC
12471If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12472output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12473file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12474
8e04817f
AC
12475Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12476from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12477@end table
12478
8e04817f
AC
12479@node Numbers
12480@section Numbers
12481@cindex number representation
12482@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12483
8e04817f
AC
12484You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12485@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12486@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12487begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12488default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12489numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12490change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12491radix} command.
104c1213 12492
8e04817f
AC
12493@table @code
12494@kindex set input-radix
12495@item set input-radix @var{base}
12496Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12497for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12498specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12499example, any of
104c1213 12500
8e04817f
AC
12501@smallexample
12502set radix 012
12503set radix 10.
12504set radix 0xa
12505@end smallexample
104c1213 12506
8e04817f
AC
12507@noindent
12508sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12509leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12510
8e04817f
AC
12511@kindex set output-radix
12512@item set output-radix @var{base}
12513Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12514for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12515specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12516
8e04817f
AC
12517@kindex show input-radix
12518@item show input-radix
12519Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12520
8e04817f
AC
12521@kindex show output-radix
12522@item show output-radix
12523Display the current default base for numeric display.
12524@end table
104c1213 12525
1e698235
DJ
12526@node ABI
12527@section Configuring the current ABI
12528
12529@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
12530application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
12531conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
12532current ABI.
12533
98b45e30
DJ
12534@cindex OS ABI
12535@kindex set osabi
12536
12537One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
12538system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
12539@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
12540but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
12541One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
12542an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
12543not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
12544platform provides.
12545
12546@table @code
12547@item show osabi
12548Show the OS ABI currently in use.
12549
12550@item set osabi
12551With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
12552
12553@item set osabi @var{abi}
12554Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
12555@end table
12556
1e698235
DJ
12557@cindex float promotion
12558@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
12559
12560Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
12561function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
12562(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
12563according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
12564(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
12565@code{double} and then passed.
12566
12567Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
12568a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
12569as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
12570
12571@table @code
12572@item set coerce-float-to-double
12573@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
12574Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
12575to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
12576
12577@item set coerce-float-to-double off
12578Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
12579functions.
12580@end table
12581
8e04817f
AC
12582@node Messages/Warnings
12583@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12584
8e04817f
AC
12585By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12586running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12587command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12588internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12589
8e04817f
AC
12590Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12591which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12592see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12593
8e04817f
AC
12594@table @code
12595@kindex set verbose
12596@item set verbose on
12597Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12598
8e04817f
AC
12599@item set verbose off
12600Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12601
8e04817f
AC
12602@kindex show verbose
12603@item show verbose
12604Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12605@end table
104c1213 12606
8e04817f
AC
12607By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12608object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12609find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12610symbol files}).
104c1213 12611
8e04817f 12612@table @code
104c1213 12613
8e04817f
AC
12614@kindex set complaints
12615@item set complaints @var{limit}
12616Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12617unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12618@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12619to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12620
8e04817f
AC
12621@kindex show complaints
12622@item show complaints
12623Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12624
8e04817f 12625@end table
104c1213 12626
8e04817f
AC
12627By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12628lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12629you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 12630
474c8240 12631@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12632(@value{GDBP}) run
12633The program being debugged has been started already.
12634Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 12635@end smallexample
104c1213 12636
8e04817f
AC
12637If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12638commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12639
8e04817f 12640@table @code
104c1213 12641
8e04817f
AC
12642@kindex set confirm
12643@cindex flinching
12644@cindex confirmation
12645@cindex stupid questions
12646@item set confirm off
12647Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12648
8e04817f
AC
12649@item set confirm on
12650Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12651
8e04817f
AC
12652@kindex show confirm
12653@item show confirm
12654Displays state of confirmation requests.
12655
12656@end table
104c1213 12657
8e04817f
AC
12658@node Debugging Output
12659@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 12660@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12661@kindex set debug arch
12662@item set debug arch
12663Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12664@kindex show debug arch
12665@item show debug arch
12666Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12667@kindex set debug event
12668@item set debug event
12669Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12670default is off.
12671@kindex show debug event
12672@item show debug event
12673Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12674info.
12675@kindex set debug expression
12676@item set debug expression
12677Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12678default is off.
12679@kindex show debug expression
12680@item show debug expression
12681Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12682debugging info.
12683@kindex set debug overload
12684@item set debug overload
12685Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12686info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12687is off.
12688@kindex show debug overload
12689@item show debug overload
12690Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12691debugging info.
12692@kindex set debug remote
12693@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12694@cindex serial connections, debugging
12695@item set debug remote
12696Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12697the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12698@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12699@kindex show debug remote
12700@item show debug remote
12701Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12702@kindex set debug serial
12703@item set debug serial
12704Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12705default is off.
12706@kindex show debug serial
12707@item show debug serial
12708Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12709info.
12710@kindex set debug target
12711@item set debug target
12712Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12713includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12714default is off.
12715@kindex show debug target
12716@item show debug target
12717Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12718info.
12719@kindex set debug varobj
12720@item set debug varobj
12721Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12722info. The default is off.
12723@kindex show debug varobj
12724@item show debug varobj
12725Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12726debugging info.
12727@end table
104c1213 12728
8e04817f
AC
12729@node Sequences
12730@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 12731
8e04817f
AC
12732Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12733command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12734commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12735files.
104c1213 12736
8e04817f
AC
12737@menu
12738* Define:: User-defined commands
12739* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12740* Command Files:: Command files
12741* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12742@end menu
104c1213 12743
8e04817f
AC
12744@node Define
12745@section User-defined commands
104c1213 12746
8e04817f
AC
12747@cindex user-defined command
12748A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12749which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12750@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12751separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12752via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 12753
8e04817f
AC
12754@smallexample
12755define adder
12756 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12757@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12758
12759@noindent
8e04817f 12760To execute the command use:
104c1213 12761
8e04817f
AC
12762@smallexample
12763adder 1 2 3
12764@end smallexample
104c1213 12765
8e04817f
AC
12766@noindent
12767This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12768its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12769reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12770functions calls.
104c1213
JM
12771
12772@table @code
104c1213 12773
8e04817f
AC
12774@kindex define
12775@item define @var{commandname}
12776Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12777by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 12778
8e04817f
AC
12779The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12780which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12781commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12782
8e04817f
AC
12783@kindex if
12784@kindex else
12785@item if
12786Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12787It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12788only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12789There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12790by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12791was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12792
8e04817f
AC
12793@kindex while
12794@item while
12795The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12796which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12797execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12798The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12799evaluates to true.
104c1213 12800
8e04817f
AC
12801@kindex document
12802@item document @var{commandname}
12803Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12804accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12805defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12806reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12807After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12808@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 12809
8e04817f
AC
12810You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12811documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12812does not change the documentation.
104c1213 12813
8e04817f
AC
12814@kindex help user-defined
12815@item help user-defined
12816List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12817(if any) for each.
104c1213 12818
8e04817f
AC
12819@kindex show user
12820@item show user
12821@itemx show user @var{commandname}
12822Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12823not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12824definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 12825
20f01a46
DH
12826@kindex show max-user-call-depth
12827@kindex set max-user-call-depth
12828@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
12829@itemx set max-user-call-depth
12830The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
12831levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
12832infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 12833
104c1213
JM
12834@end table
12835
8e04817f
AC
12836When user-defined commands are executed, the
12837commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12838stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 12839
8e04817f
AC
12840If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12841without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12842commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12843messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 12844
8e04817f
AC
12845@node Hooks
12846@section User-defined command hooks
12847@cindex command hooks
12848@cindex hooks, for commands
12849@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 12850
8e04817f
AC
12851@kindex hook
12852@kindex hook-
12853You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12854command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12855command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12856before that command.
104c1213 12857
8e04817f
AC
12858@cindex hooks, post-command
12859@kindex hookpost
12860@kindex hookpost-
12861A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12862Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12863@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12864that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12865pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 12866
8e04817f
AC
12867It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12868occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 12869
8e04817f
AC
12870@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12871@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 12872
8e04817f
AC
12873@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12874In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12875(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12876execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12877displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 12878
8e04817f
AC
12879For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12880single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12881you could define:
104c1213 12882
474c8240 12883@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12884define hook-stop
12885handle SIGALRM nopass
12886end
104c1213 12887
8e04817f
AC
12888define hook-run
12889handle SIGALRM pass
12890end
104c1213 12891
8e04817f
AC
12892define hook-continue
12893handle SIGLARM pass
12894end
474c8240 12895@end smallexample
104c1213 12896
8e04817f
AC
12897As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12898command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12899you could define:
104c1213 12900
474c8240 12901@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12902define hook-echo
12903echo <<<---
12904end
104c1213 12905
8e04817f
AC
12906define hookpost-echo
12907echo --->>>\n
12908end
104c1213 12909
8e04817f
AC
12910(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12911<<<---Hello World--->>>
12912(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 12913
474c8240 12914@end smallexample
104c1213 12915
8e04817f
AC
12916You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12917not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12918name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12919@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12920@c or not?
12921If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12922@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12923(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 12924
8e04817f
AC
12925If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12926get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 12927
8e04817f
AC
12928@node Command Files
12929@section Command files
c906108c 12930
8e04817f
AC
12931@cindex command files
12932A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12933commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12934An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
12935the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 12936
8e04817f
AC
12937@cindex init file
12938@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
12939@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
12940When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
12941@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
12942port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
12943limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
12944During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 12945
8e04817f
AC
12946@enumerate
12947@item
12948Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12949DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12950@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 12951
8e04817f
AC
12952@item
12953Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 12954
8e04817f
AC
12955@item
12956Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 12957
8e04817f
AC
12958@item
12959Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12960@end enumerate
c906108c 12961
8e04817f
AC
12962The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12963complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12964and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12965option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12966
8e04817f
AC
12967@cindex init file name
12968On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12969different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12970form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12971different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12972environments with special init file names:
c906108c 12973
8e04817f
AC
12974@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12975@itemize @bullet
12976@item
12977VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12978
8e04817f
AC
12979@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12980@item
12981OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12982
8e04817f
AC
12983@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12984@item
12985ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12986@end itemize
c906108c 12987
8e04817f
AC
12988You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12989@code{source} command:
c906108c 12990
8e04817f
AC
12991@table @code
12992@kindex source
12993@item source @var{filename}
12994Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
12995@end table
12996
8e04817f 12997The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
a71ec265
DH
12998printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
12999execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
c906108c 13000
8e04817f
AC
13001Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13002without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13003normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13004when called from command files.
c906108c 13005
8e04817f
AC
13006@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13007mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13008standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13009not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13010the next command.
c906108c 13011
474c8240 13012@smallexample
8e04817f 13013gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 13014@end smallexample
c906108c 13015
8e04817f
AC
13016(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13017will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13018would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 13019
8e04817f
AC
13020@node Output
13021@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 13022
8e04817f
AC
13023During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13024@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13025explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13026describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13027want.
c906108c
SS
13028
13029@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13030@kindex echo
13031@item echo @var{text}
13032@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13033@c because it is not in ANSI.
13034Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13035@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13036newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13037In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13038by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13039string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13040trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13041To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13042@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 13043
8e04817f
AC
13044A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13045the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 13046
474c8240 13047@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13048echo This is some text\n\
13049which is continued\n\
13050onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13051@end smallexample
c906108c 13052
8e04817f 13053produces the same output as
c906108c 13054
474c8240 13055@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13056echo This is some text\n
13057echo which is continued\n
13058echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13059@end smallexample
c906108c 13060
8e04817f
AC
13061@kindex output
13062@item output @var{expression}
13063Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13064newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13065value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13066on expressions.
c906108c 13067
8e04817f
AC
13068@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13069Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13070the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13071formats}, for more information.
c906108c 13072
8e04817f
AC
13073@kindex printf
13074@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13075Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13076@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13077either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13078@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13079subroutine
13080@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13081@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13082@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13083@c supported.
c906108c 13084
474c8240 13085@smallexample
8e04817f 13086printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 13087@end smallexample
c906108c 13088
8e04817f 13089For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 13090
8e04817f
AC
13091@smallexample
13092printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13093@end smallexample
c906108c 13094
8e04817f
AC
13095The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13096string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13097letter.
c906108c
SS
13098@end table
13099
8e04817f
AC
13100@node TUI
13101@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13102@cindex TUI
c906108c 13103
8e04817f
AC
13104@menu
13105* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13106* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
7cf36c78 13107* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
8e04817f
AC
13108* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13109* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13110@end menu
c906108c 13111
8e04817f
AC
13112The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13113is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13114to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13115and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13116The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13117with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 13118
8e04817f
AC
13119@node TUI Overview
13120@section TUI overview
c906108c 13121
8e04817f
AC
13122The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13123@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 13124
8e04817f
AC
13125@itemize @bullet
13126@item
13127A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13128windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13129
8e04817f
AC
13130@item
13131A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13132the TUI.
13133@end itemize
c906108c 13134
8e04817f
AC
13135In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13136on the terminal:
c906108c 13137
8e04817f
AC
13138@table @emph
13139@item command
13140This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13141prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13142managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13143window is always visible.
c906108c 13144
8e04817f
AC
13145@item source
13146The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13147line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
c906108c 13148
8e04817f
AC
13149@item assembly
13150The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 13151
8e04817f
AC
13152@item register
13153This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13154a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13155changed are highlighted.
c906108c 13156
c906108c
SS
13157@end table
13158
269c21fe
SC
13159The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13160by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13161Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13162indicates the breakpoint type:
13163
13164@table @code
13165@item B
13166Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13167
13168@item b
13169Breakpoint which was never hit.
13170
13171@item H
13172Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13173
13174@item h
13175Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13176
13177@end table
13178
13179The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13180
13181@table @code
13182@item +
13183Breakpoint is enabled.
13184
13185@item -
13186Breakpoint is disabled.
13187
13188@end table
13189
8e04817f
AC
13190The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13191and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13192changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13193These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13194layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13195The following layouts are available:
c906108c 13196
8e04817f
AC
13197@itemize @bullet
13198@item
13199source
2df3850c 13200
8e04817f
AC
13201@item
13202assembly
13203
13204@item
13205source and assembly
13206
13207@item
13208source and registers
c906108c 13209
8e04817f
AC
13210@item
13211assembly and registers
2df3850c 13212
8e04817f 13213@end itemize
c906108c 13214
b7bb15bc
SC
13215On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13216concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13217updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13218are displayed:
13219
13220@table @emph
13221@item target
13222Indicates the current gdb target
13223(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13224
13225@item process
13226Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13227When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13228
13229@item function
13230Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13231The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13232When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13233the string @code{??} is displayed.
13234
13235@item line
13236Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13237When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13238
13239@item pc
13240Indicates the current program counter address.
13241
13242@end table
13243
8e04817f
AC
13244@node TUI Keys
13245@section TUI Key Bindings
13246@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 13247
8e04817f
AC
13248The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13249(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13250They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
7cf36c78
SC
13251directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13252a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13253@value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
8e04817f 13254are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 13255
8e04817f
AC
13256@table @kbd
13257@kindex C-x C-a
13258@item C-x C-a
13259@kindex C-x a
13260@itemx C-x a
13261@kindex C-x A
13262@itemx C-x A
13263Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13264the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13265its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13266mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13267The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 13268
8e04817f
AC
13269@kindex C-x 1
13270@item C-x 1
13271Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13272either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13273is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 13274
8e04817f 13275Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 13276
8e04817f
AC
13277@kindex C-x 2
13278@item C-x 2
13279Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13280layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13281When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13282previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 13283
8e04817f 13284Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 13285
7cf36c78
SC
13286@kindex C-x s
13287@item C-x s
13288Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13289(@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13290
c906108c
SS
13291@end table
13292
8e04817f 13293The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 13294
8e04817f
AC
13295@table @key
13296@kindex PgUp
13297@item PgUp
13298Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 13299
8e04817f
AC
13300@kindex PgDn
13301@item PgDn
13302Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 13303
8e04817f
AC
13304@kindex Up
13305@item Up
13306Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 13307
8e04817f
AC
13308@kindex Down
13309@item Down
13310Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 13311
8e04817f
AC
13312@kindex Left
13313@item Left
13314Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 13315
8e04817f
AC
13316@kindex Right
13317@item Right
13318Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 13319
8e04817f
AC
13320@kindex C-L
13321@item C-L
13322Refresh the screen.
c906108c 13323
8e04817f 13324@end table
c906108c 13325
8e04817f
AC
13326In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13327for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13328necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13329@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13330
7cf36c78
SC
13331@node TUI Single Key Mode
13332@section TUI Single Key Mode
13333@cindex TUI single key mode
13334
13335The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13336key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13337some gdb commands.
13338
13339@table @kbd
13340@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13341@item c
13342continue
13343
13344@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13345@item d
13346down
13347
13348@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13349@item f
13350finish
13351
13352@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13353@item n
13354next
13355
13356@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13357@item q
13358exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13359
13360@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13361@item r
13362run
13363
13364@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13365@item s
13366step
13367
13368@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13369@item u
13370up
13371
13372@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13373@item v
13374info locals
13375
13376@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13377@item w
13378where
13379
13380@end table
13381
13382Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13383The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13384it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13385with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13386@emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13387this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13388
13389
8e04817f
AC
13390@node TUI Commands
13391@section TUI specific commands
13392@cindex TUI commands
13393
13394The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13395These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13396the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13397is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13398in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
13399
13400@table @code
3d757584
SC
13401@item info win
13402@kindex info win
13403List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13404
8e04817f
AC
13405@item layout next
13406@kindex layout next
13407Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13408
8e04817f
AC
13409@item layout prev
13410@kindex layout prev
13411Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13412
8e04817f
AC
13413@item layout src
13414@kindex layout src
13415Display the source window only.
c906108c 13416
8e04817f
AC
13417@item layout asm
13418@kindex layout asm
13419Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13420
8e04817f
AC
13421@item layout split
13422@kindex layout split
13423Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13424
8e04817f
AC
13425@item layout regs
13426@kindex layout regs
13427Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13428
13429@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13430@kindex focus
13431Set the focus to the named window.
13432This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13433can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13434
8e04817f
AC
13435@item refresh
13436@kindex refresh
13437Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13438
8e04817f
AC
13439@item update
13440@kindex update
13441Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13442
8e04817f
AC
13443@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13444@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13445@kindex winheight
13446Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13447lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13448decrease it.
2df3850c 13449
c906108c
SS
13450@end table
13451
8e04817f
AC
13452@node TUI Configuration
13453@section TUI configuration variables
13454@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13455
8e04817f
AC
13456The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13457appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13458
8e04817f
AC
13459@table @code
13460@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13461@kindex set tui border-kind
13462Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13463The possible values are the following:
13464@table @code
13465@item space
13466Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13467
8e04817f
AC
13468@item ascii
13469Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13470
8e04817f
AC
13471@item acs
13472Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13473drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13474
8e04817f 13475@end table
c78b4128 13476
8e04817f
AC
13477@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13478@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13479Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13480The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13481@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13482
8e04817f
AC
13483@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13484@kindex set tui border-mode
13485Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13486The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13487@table @code
13488@item normal
13489Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13490
8e04817f
AC
13491@item standout
13492Use standout mode.
c906108c 13493
8e04817f
AC
13494@item reverse
13495Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13496
8e04817f
AC
13497@item half
13498Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13499
8e04817f
AC
13500@item half-standout
13501Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13502
8e04817f
AC
13503@item bold
13504Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13505
8e04817f
AC
13506@item bold-standout
13507Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13508
8e04817f 13509@end table
c78b4128 13510
8e04817f 13511@end table
c78b4128 13512
8e04817f
AC
13513@node Emacs
13514@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13515
8e04817f
AC
13516@cindex Emacs
13517@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13518A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13519edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13520@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13521
8e04817f
AC
13522To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13523executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13524@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13525created Emacs buffer.
13526@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13527
8e04817f
AC
13528Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13529things:
c906108c 13530
8e04817f
AC
13531@itemize @bullet
13532@item
13533All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13534@end itemize
c906108c 13535
8e04817f
AC
13536This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13537and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13538
8e04817f
AC
13539This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13540commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13541in this way.
bf0184be 13542
8e04817f
AC
13543All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13544with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13545way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13546stop.
bf0184be 13547
8e04817f 13548@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13549@item
8e04817f
AC
13550@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13551@end itemize
bf0184be 13552
8e04817f
AC
13553Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13554source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13555left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13556source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13557and the source.
bf0184be 13558
8e04817f
AC
13559Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13560usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13561
8e04817f
AC
13562@quotation
13563@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13564current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13565the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13566appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13567environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13568session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13569back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13570avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13571your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13572@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13573
8e04817f
AC
13574A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13575switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13576@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13577@end quotation
13578
13579By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13580you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13581several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13582Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13583
474c8240 13584@smallexample
8e04817f 13585(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
474c8240 13586@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13587
13588@noindent
13589(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13590in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13591``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13592
13593In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13594addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 13595
8e04817f
AC
13596@table @kbd
13597@item C-h m
13598Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 13599
8e04817f
AC
13600@item M-s
13601Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13602update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13603
8e04817f
AC
13604@item M-n
13605Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13606calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13607to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13608
8e04817f
AC
13609@item M-i
13610Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13611display window accordingly.
c906108c 13612
8e04817f
AC
13613@item M-x gdb-nexti
13614Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13615display window accordingly.
c906108c 13616
8e04817f
AC
13617@item C-c C-f
13618Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13619@code{finish} command.
c906108c 13620
8e04817f
AC
13621@item M-c
13622Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13623command.
b433d00b 13624
8e04817f 13625@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 13626
8e04817f
AC
13627@item M-u
13628Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13629(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13630like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 13631
8e04817f 13632@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 13633
8e04817f
AC
13634@item M-d
13635Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13636@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 13637
8e04817f 13638@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 13639
8e04817f
AC
13640@item C-x &
13641Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13642of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13643around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13644then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13645argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 13646
8e04817f
AC
13647You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13648@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13649otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13650inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13651wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13652list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13653formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13654is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13655@end table
c906108c 13656
8e04817f
AC
13657In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13658tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 13659
8e04817f
AC
13660If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13661it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13662request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13663the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13664frame.
c906108c 13665
8e04817f
AC
13666The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13667which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13668the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13669communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13670delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13671to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 13672
8e04817f
AC
13673@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13674@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13675@ignore
13676@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13677@kindex Epoch
13678@kindex inspect
c906108c 13679
8e04817f
AC
13680Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13681called the @code{epoch}
13682environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13683@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13684each value is printed in its own window.
13685@end ignore
c906108c 13686
8e04817f
AC
13687@include annotate.texi
13688@include gdbmi.texinfo
c906108c 13689
8e04817f
AC
13690@node GDB Bugs
13691@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13692@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13693@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 13694
8e04817f 13695Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 13696
8e04817f
AC
13697Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13698may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13699the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13700reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13701
8e04817f
AC
13702In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13703information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
13704
13705@menu
8e04817f
AC
13706* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13707* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
13708@end menu
13709
8e04817f
AC
13710@node Bug Criteria
13711@section Have you found a bug?
13712@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 13713
8e04817f 13714If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
13715
13716@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
13717@cindex fatal signal
13718@cindex debugger crash
13719@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 13720@item
8e04817f
AC
13721If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13722@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13723
13724@cindex error on valid input
13725@item
13726If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13727bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13728somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 13729
8e04817f 13730@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 13731@item
8e04817f
AC
13732If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13733that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13734``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13735for traditional practice''.
13736
13737@item
13738If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13739for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
13740@end itemize
13741
8e04817f
AC
13742@node Bug Reporting
13743@section How to report bugs
13744@cindex bug reports
13745@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13746
13747A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13748If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13749contact that organization first.
13750
13751You can find contact information for many support companies and
13752individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13753distribution.
13754@c should add a web page ref...
13755
129188f6
AC
13756In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
13757@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
13758@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
13759page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
13760be used.
8e04817f
AC
13761
13762@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13763@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13764not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13765@samp{bug-gdb}.
13766
13767The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13768serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13769the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13770newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13771problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13772path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13773we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13774bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 13775
8e04817f
AC
13776The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13777@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13778fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 13779
8e04817f
AC
13780Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13781problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13782assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13783Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13784stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13785name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13786of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13787the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13788easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 13789
8e04817f
AC
13790Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13791bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13792you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13793self-contained.
c4555f82 13794
8e04817f
AC
13795Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13796bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13797@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13798bugs properly.
13799
13800To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
13801
13802@itemize @bullet
13803@item
8e04817f
AC
13804The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13805with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13806version}.
c4555f82 13807
8e04817f
AC
13808Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13809the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
13810
13811@item
8e04817f
AC
13812The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13813version number.
c4555f82
SC
13814
13815@item
8e04817f
AC
13816What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13817``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
13818
13819@item
8e04817f
AC
13820What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13821debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13822C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13823information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13824compilers.
c4555f82 13825
8e04817f
AC
13826@item
13827The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13828observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13829you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13830Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 13831
8e04817f
AC
13832If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13833and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 13834
8e04817f
AC
13835@item
13836A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13837reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 13838
8e04817f
AC
13839@item
13840A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13841incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 13842
8e04817f
AC
13843Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13844will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13845not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13846a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 13847
8e04817f
AC
13848Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13849say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13850copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13851the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13852crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13853ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13854us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13855to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 13856
8e04817f
AC
13857@item
13858If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13859diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13860it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 13861
8e04817f
AC
13862The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13863sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 13864
8e04817f 13865@end itemize
c4555f82 13866
8e04817f 13867Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 13868
8e04817f
AC
13869@itemize @bullet
13870@item
13871A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 13872
8e04817f
AC
13873Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13874which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13875changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 13876
8e04817f
AC
13877This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13878will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13879with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13880We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 13881
8e04817f
AC
13882Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13883of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13884output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13885less time, and so on.
c4555f82 13886
8e04817f
AC
13887However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13888report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 13889
8e04817f
AC
13890@item
13891A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 13892
8e04817f
AC
13893A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13894the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13895a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13896to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 13897
8e04817f
AC
13898Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13899construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13900through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13901to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 13902
8e04817f
AC
13903And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13904patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13905help us to understand.
c4555f82 13906
8e04817f
AC
13907@item
13908A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 13909
8e04817f
AC
13910Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13911things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13912@end itemize
c4555f82 13913
8e04817f
AC
13914@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13915@c and consists of the two following files:
13916@c rluser.texinfo
13917@c inc-hist.texinfo
13918@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13919@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13920@include rluser.texinfo
13921@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 13922
c4555f82 13923
8e04817f
AC
13924@node Formatting Documentation
13925@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 13926
8e04817f
AC
13927@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13928@cindex reference card
13929The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13930for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13931subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13932@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13933release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13934you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 13935
8e04817f
AC
13936The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13937can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 13938
474c8240 13939@smallexample
8e04817f 13940make refcard.dvi
474c8240 13941@end smallexample
c4555f82 13942
8e04817f
AC
13943The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13944mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
13945that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13946high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13947your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 13948
8e04817f 13949@cindex documentation
c4555f82 13950
8e04817f
AC
13951All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13952distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13953a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13954on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13955formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13956and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 13957
8e04817f
AC
13958@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13959version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13960file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13961subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13962necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13963but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13964Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13965@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 13966
8e04817f
AC
13967If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13968Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13969@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 13970
8e04817f
AC
13971If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13972@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13973version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 13974
474c8240 13975@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13976cd gdb
13977make gdb.info
474c8240 13978@end smallexample
c4555f82 13979
8e04817f
AC
13980If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13981a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13982Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 13983
8e04817f
AC
13984@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13985produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13986document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13987has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13988command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13989(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13990require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 13991
8e04817f
AC
13992@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13993@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13994written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13995typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13996and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13997directory.
c4555f82 13998
8e04817f
AC
13999If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
14000typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
14001subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
14002@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 14003
474c8240 14004@smallexample
8e04817f 14005make gdb.dvi
474c8240 14006@end smallexample
c4555f82 14007
8e04817f 14008Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 14009
8e04817f
AC
14010@node Installing GDB
14011@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14012@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14013@cindex installation
c4555f82 14014
8e04817f
AC
14015@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14016of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14017build the @code{gdb} program.
14018@iftex
14019@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14020@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14021look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14022installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14023@end iftex
c4555f82 14024
8e04817f
AC
14025The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14026@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
14027appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 14028
8e04817f
AC
14029For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14030@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 14031
8e04817f
AC
14032@table @code
14033@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14034script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 14035
8e04817f
AC
14036@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14037the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 14038
8e04817f
AC
14039@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14040source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 14041
8e04817f
AC
14042@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14043@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 14044
8e04817f
AC
14045@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14046source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 14047
8e04817f
AC
14048@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14049source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 14050
8e04817f
AC
14051@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14052source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 14053
8e04817f
AC
14054@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14055source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 14056
8e04817f
AC
14057@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14058source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14059@end table
c906108c 14060
8e04817f
AC
14061The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14062from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14063this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 14064
8e04817f
AC
14065First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14066if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14067identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14068argument.
c906108c 14069
8e04817f 14070For example:
c906108c 14071
474c8240 14072@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14073cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14074./configure @var{host}
14075make
474c8240 14076@end smallexample
c906108c 14077
8e04817f
AC
14078@noindent
14079where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14080@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14081(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14082correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 14083
8e04817f
AC
14084Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14085@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14086libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14087binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 14088
8e04817f
AC
14089@need 750
14090@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14091system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14092shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 14093
474c8240 14094@smallexample
8e04817f 14095sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 14096@end smallexample
c906108c 14097
8e04817f
AC
14098If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14099directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14100@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14101creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14102you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14103
14104You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
14105subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
14106configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
c906108c 14107
8e04817f
AC
14108For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
14109the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
c906108c 14110
474c8240 14111@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14112@group
14113cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14114../configure @var{host}
14115@end group
474c8240 14116@end smallexample
c906108c 14117
8e04817f
AC
14118You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14119However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14120the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14121that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14122let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 14123
8e04817f
AC
14124@menu
14125* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14126* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14127* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14128@end menu
c906108c 14129
8e04817f
AC
14130@node Separate Objdir
14131@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 14132
8e04817f
AC
14133If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14134you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14135host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14136allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14137rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14138handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14139@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14140program specified there.
c906108c 14141
8e04817f
AC
14142To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14143with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14144(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14145itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14146would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14147the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 14148
8e04817f
AC
14149For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
14150separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 14151
474c8240 14152@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14153@group
14154cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14155mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14156cd ../gdb-sun4
14157../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14158make
14159@end group
474c8240 14160@end smallexample
c906108c 14161
8e04817f
AC
14162When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14163directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14164(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14165the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14166directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14167@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 14168
8e04817f
AC
14169One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
14170directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14171@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14172programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14173You specify a cross-debugging target by
14174giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 14175
8e04817f
AC
14176When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14177it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14178called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 14179
8e04817f
AC
14180The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14181directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14182directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14183directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14184will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 14185
8e04817f
AC
14186When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14187directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14188if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14189with each other.
c906108c 14190
8e04817f
AC
14191@node Config Names
14192@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 14193
8e04817f
AC
14194The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14195script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14196aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14197of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 14198
474c8240 14199@smallexample
8e04817f 14200@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 14201@end smallexample
c906108c 14202
8e04817f
AC
14203For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14204or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14205option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 14206
8e04817f
AC
14207The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14208any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14209aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14210@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14211script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14212abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 14213
8e04817f
AC
14214@smallexample
14215% sh config.sub i386-linux
14216i386-pc-linux-gnu
14217% sh config.sub alpha-linux
14218alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14219% sh config.sub hp9k700
14220hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14221% sh config.sub sun4
14222sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14223% sh config.sub sun3
14224m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14225% sh config.sub i986v
14226Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14227@end smallexample
c906108c 14228
8e04817f
AC
14229@noindent
14230@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14231directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 14232
8e04817f
AC
14233@node Configure Options
14234@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 14235
8e04817f
AC
14236Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14237are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14238several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14239Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 14240
474c8240 14241@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14242configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14243 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14244 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14245 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14246 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14247 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14248 @var{host}
474c8240 14249@end smallexample
c906108c 14250
8e04817f
AC
14251@noindent
14252You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14253@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14254@samp{--}.
c906108c 14255
8e04817f
AC
14256@table @code
14257@item --help
14258Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 14259
8e04817f
AC
14260@item --prefix=@var{dir}
14261Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14262@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14263
8e04817f
AC
14264@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14265Configure the source to install programs under directory
14266@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14267
8e04817f
AC
14268@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14269@need 2000
14270@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14271@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14272@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14273Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14274@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14275build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14276directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14277the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14278directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14279the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14280@var{dirname}.
c906108c 14281
8e04817f
AC
14282@item --norecursion
14283Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14284propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 14285
8e04817f
AC
14286@item --target=@var{target}
14287Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14288@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14289programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 14290
8e04817f 14291There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 14292
8e04817f
AC
14293@item @var{host} @dots{}
14294Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 14295
8e04817f
AC
14296There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14297@end table
c906108c 14298
8e04817f
AC
14299There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14300needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 14301
8e04817f
AC
14302@node Maintenance Commands
14303@appendix Maintenance Commands
14304@cindex maintenance commands
14305@cindex internal commands
c906108c 14306
8e04817f
AC
14307In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14308includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14309These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 14310
8e04817f
AC
14311@table @code
14312@kindex maint info breakpoints
14313@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14314Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14315breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14316internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14317breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14318is shown:
c906108c 14319
8e04817f
AC
14320@table @code
14321@item breakpoint
14322Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 14323
8e04817f
AC
14324@item watchpoint
14325Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 14326
8e04817f
AC
14327@item longjmp
14328Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14329@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 14330
8e04817f
AC
14331@item longjmp resume
14332Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 14333
8e04817f
AC
14334@item until
14335Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 14336
8e04817f
AC
14337@item finish
14338Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 14339
8e04817f
AC
14340@item shlib events
14341Shared library events.
c906108c 14342
8e04817f 14343@end table
c906108c 14344
8d30a00d
AC
14345@kindex maint internal-error
14346@kindex maint internal-warning
14347@item maint internal-error
14348@itemx maint internal-warning
14349Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
14350or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
14351or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
14352internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
14353either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
14354@value{GDBN} session.
14355
14356@smallexample
14357(gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
14358@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
14359A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
14360debugging may prove unreliable.
14361Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14362Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14363(gdb)
14364@end smallexample
14365
14366Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
14367warning message.
14368
0680b120
AC
14369@kindex maint print registers
14370@kindex maint print raw-registers
14371@kindex maint print cooked-registers
14372@item maint print registers
14373@itemx maint print raw-registers
14374@itemx maint print cooked-registers
14375Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
14376
14377The command @samp{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
14378the raw register cache; and the command @samp{maint print
14379cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers.
14380@xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint, @value{GDBN} Internals}.
14381
14382Takes an optional file parameter.
14383
8e04817f 14384@end table
c906108c 14385
c906108c 14386
e0ce93ac 14387@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 14388@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 14389
ee2d5c50
AC
14390@menu
14391* Overview::
14392* Packets::
14393* Stop Reply Packets::
14394* General Query Packets::
14395* Register Packet Format::
14396* Examples::
14397@end menu
14398
14399@node Overview
14400@section Overview
14401
8e04817f
AC
14402There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14403protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14404machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14405recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 14406
d2c6833e 14407In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
8e04817f 14408transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 14409
8e04817f
AC
14410@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14411@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14412@cindex remote serial protocol
14413All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14414sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14415@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14416@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 14417
474c8240 14418@smallexample
8e04817f 14419@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14420@end smallexample
8e04817f 14421@noindent
c906108c 14422
8e04817f
AC
14423@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14424@noindent
14425The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14426characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14427eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 14428
8e04817f
AC
14429Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14430specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 14431
474c8240 14432@smallexample
8e04817f 14433@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14434@end smallexample
c906108c 14435
8e04817f
AC
14436@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14437@noindent
14438That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14439has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14440since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 14441
8e04817f
AC
14442@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14443When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14444response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14445the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14446retransmission):
c906108c 14447
474c8240 14448@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
14449-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14450<- @code{+}
474c8240 14451@end smallexample
8e04817f 14452@noindent
53a5351d 14453
8e04817f
AC
14454The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14455debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14456the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14457when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 14458
8e04817f
AC
14459@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14460exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14461exceptions).
c906108c 14462
8e04817f 14463Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
ee2d5c50 14464@cindex remote protocol, field separator
8e04817f 14465@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
ee2d5c50 14466@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 14467
8e04817f
AC
14468Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14469@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14470would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 14471
8e04817f
AC
14472Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14473means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14474which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14475@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14476where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14477characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14478value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 14479
8e04817f
AC
14480Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14481loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14482character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 14483
8e04817f 14484So:
474c8240 14485@smallexample
8e04817f 14486"@code{0* }"
474c8240 14487@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14488@noindent
14489means the same as "0000".
c906108c 14490
8e04817f
AC
14491The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14492error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 14493
8e04817f
AC
14494For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14495(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14496protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14497on that response.
c906108c 14498
8e04817f
AC
14499A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14500@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14501optional.
c906108c 14502
ee2d5c50
AC
14503@node Packets
14504@section Packets
14505
14506The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
14507@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
14508
14509@table @r
14510
14511@item @code{!} --- extended mode
14512@cindex @code{!} packet
14513
8e04817f
AC
14514Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14515persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14516debugged.
ee2d5c50
AC
14517
14518Reply:
14519@table @samp
14520@item OK
8e04817f 14521The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
ee2d5c50 14522@end table
c906108c 14523
ee2d5c50
AC
14524@item @code{?} --- last signal
14525@cindex @code{?} packet
c906108c 14526
ee2d5c50
AC
14527Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
14528step and continue.
c906108c 14529
ee2d5c50
AC
14530Reply:
14531@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14532
14533@item @code{a} --- reserved
14534
14535Reserved for future use.
14536
14537@item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14538@cindex @code{A} packet
c906108c 14539
8e04817f
AC
14540Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14541specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14542See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
14543
14544Reply:
14545@table @samp
14546@item OK
14547@item E@var{NN}
14548@end table
14549
14550@item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14551@cindex @code{b} packet
14552
14553Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
14554
14555JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
14556received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
14557problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
14558
14559Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
14560it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
14561some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
14562switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
14563of view, nothing actually happened.}
14564
14565@item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14566@cindex @code{B} packet
14567
8e04817f 14568Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
2f870471
AC
14569breakpoint at @var{addr}.
14570
14571This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
14572(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
c906108c 14573
ee2d5c50
AC
14574@item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
14575@cindex @code{c} packet
14576
14577@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8e04817f 14578current address.
c906108c 14579
ee2d5c50
AC
14580Reply:
14581@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14582
14583@item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
14584@cindex @code{C} packet
14585
8e04817f
AC
14586Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14587@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
c906108c 14588
ee2d5c50
AC
14589Reply:
14590@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
c906108c 14591
ee2d5c50
AC
14592@item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14593@cindex @code{d} packet
14594
14595Toggle debug flag.
14596
14597@item @code{D} --- detach
14598@cindex @code{D} packet
14599
14600Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
14601before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
14602
14603Reply:
14604@table @samp
14605@item @emph{no response}
8e04817f 14606@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
ee2d5c50 14607@end table
c906108c 14608
ee2d5c50 14609@item @code{e} --- reserved
c906108c 14610
ee2d5c50 14611Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14612
ee2d5c50 14613@item @code{E} --- reserved
c906108c 14614
ee2d5c50 14615Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14616
ee2d5c50
AC
14617@item @code{f} --- reserved
14618
14619Reserved for future use.
14620
14621@item @code{F} --- reserved
14622
14623Reserved for future use.
14624
14625@item @code{g} --- read registers
14626@anchor{read registers packet}
14627@cindex @code{g} packet
14628
14629Read general registers.
14630
14631Reply:
14632@table @samp
14633@item @var{XX@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
14634Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14635with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14636each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
ee2d5c50
AC
14637determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
14638and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8e04817f 14639@code{g} packets is specified below.
ee2d5c50
AC
14640@item E@var{NN}
14641for an error.
14642@end table
c906108c 14643
ee2d5c50
AC
14644@item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
14645@cindex @code{G} packet
c906108c 14646
ee2d5c50
AC
14647@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
14648data.
14649
14650Reply:
14651@table @samp
14652@item OK
14653for success
14654@item E@var{NN}
14655for an error
14656@end table
14657
14658@item @code{h} --- reserved
14659
14660Reserved for future use.
14661
14662@item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
14663@cindex @code{H} packet
c906108c 14664
8e04817f 14665Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
ee2d5c50
AC
14666@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
14667should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
14668operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
14669the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
14670
14671Reply:
14672@table @samp
14673@item OK
14674for success
14675@item E@var{NN}
14676for an error
14677@end table
c906108c 14678
8e04817f
AC
14679@c FIXME: JTC:
14680@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14681@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14682@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14683@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14684@c described. For example:
14685@c
14686@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14687@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14688@c otherwise returns current registers.
14689@c
14690@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14691@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14692@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 14693
ee2d5c50
AC
14694@item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14695@anchor{cycle step packet}
14696@cindex @code{i} packet
14697
8e04817f
AC
14698Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14699present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14700step starting at that address.
c906108c 14701
ee2d5c50
AC
14702@item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14703@cindex @code{I} packet
14704
14705@xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
14706
14707@item @code{j} --- reserved
14708
14709Reserved for future use.
14710
14711@item @code{J} --- reserved
c906108c 14712
ee2d5c50 14713Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14714
ee2d5c50
AC
14715@item @code{k} --- kill request
14716@cindex @code{k} packet
c906108c 14717
ac282366 14718FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
ee2d5c50
AC
14719thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
14720thread?)}.
c906108c 14721
ee2d5c50 14722@item @code{K} --- reserved
c906108c 14723
ee2d5c50
AC
14724Reserved for future use.
14725
14726@item @code{l} --- reserved
14727
14728Reserved for future use.
14729
14730@item @code{L} --- reserved
14731
14732Reserved for future use.
14733
14734@item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
14735@cindex @code{m} packet
c906108c 14736
8e04817f 14737Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50 14738Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
2e834e49 14739assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8e04817f 14740transfer mechanism is needed.}
c906108c 14741
ee2d5c50
AC
14742Reply:
14743@table @samp
14744@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14745@var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14746to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
2e834e49 14747that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
ee2d5c50
AC
14748accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
14749needed.}
14750@item E@var{NN}
14751@var{NN} is errno
14752@end table
14753
14754@item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
14755@cindex @code{M} packet
14756
8e04817f 14757Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14758@var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
14759
14760Reply:
14761@table @samp
14762@item OK
14763for success
14764@item E@var{NN}
8e04817f
AC
14765for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14766written).
ee2d5c50 14767@end table
c906108c 14768
ee2d5c50 14769@item @code{n} --- reserved
c906108c 14770
ee2d5c50 14771Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14772
ee2d5c50 14773@item @code{N} --- reserved
c906108c 14774
ee2d5c50 14775Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14776
ee2d5c50
AC
14777@item @code{o} --- reserved
14778
14779Reserved for future use.
14780
14781@item @code{O} --- reserved
14782
14783Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14784
ee2d5c50
AC
14785@item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
14786@cindex @code{p} packet
14787
14788@xref{write register packet}.
14789
14790Reply:
14791@table @samp
14792@item @var{r@dots{}.}
14793The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
14794@end table
14795
14796@item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
14797@anchor{write register packet}
14798@cindex @code{P} packet
14799
14800Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
8e04817f 14801digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
c906108c 14802
ee2d5c50
AC
14803Reply:
14804@table @samp
14805@item OK
14806for success
14807@item E@var{NN}
14808for an error
14809@end table
14810
14811@item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
14812@anchor{general query packet}
14813@cindex @code{q} packet
14814
14815Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
14816leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
14817prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
14818be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
14819that they match the full @var{query} name.
14820
14821Reply:
14822@table @samp
14823@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14824Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
14825@item E@var{NN}
14826error reply
8e04817f 14827@item
ee2d5c50
AC
14828Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
14829@end table
14830
14831@item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
14832@cindex @code{Q} packet
14833
14834Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
14835
14836@xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
c906108c 14837
ee2d5c50
AC
14838@item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
14839@cindex @code{r} packet
c906108c 14840
8e04817f 14841Reset the entire system.
c906108c 14842
ee2d5c50
AC
14843@item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
14844@cindex @code{R} packet
14845
8e04817f
AC
14846Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
14847This packet is only available in extended mode.
ee2d5c50
AC
14848
14849Reply:
14850@table @samp
14851@item @emph{no reply}
8e04817f 14852The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
ee2d5c50
AC
14853@end table
14854
14855@item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
14856@cindex @code{s} packet
c906108c 14857
8e04817f
AC
14858@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14859same address.
c906108c 14860
ee2d5c50
AC
14861Reply:
14862@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14863
14864@item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
14865@anchor{step with signal packet}
14866@cindex @code{S} packet
14867
8e04817f 14868Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
c906108c 14869
ee2d5c50
AC
14870Reply:
14871@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14872
14873@item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
14874@cindex @code{t} packet
14875
8e04817f 14876Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
ee2d5c50
AC
14877@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
14878@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 14879
ee2d5c50
AC
14880@item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
14881@cindex @code{T} packet
c906108c 14882
ee2d5c50 14883Find out if the thread XX is alive.
c906108c 14884
ee2d5c50
AC
14885Reply:
14886@table @samp
14887@item OK
14888thread is still alive
14889@item E@var{NN}
14890thread is dead
14891@end table
14892
14893@item @code{u} --- reserved
14894
14895Reserved for future use.
14896
14897@item @code{U} --- reserved
14898
14899Reserved for future use.
14900
14901@item @code{v} --- reserved
14902
14903Reserved for future use.
14904
14905@item @code{V} --- reserved
c906108c 14906
ee2d5c50 14907Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14908
ee2d5c50 14909@item @code{w} --- reserved
c906108c 14910
ee2d5c50 14911Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14912
ee2d5c50 14913@item @code{W} --- reserved
c906108c 14914
ee2d5c50 14915Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14916
ee2d5c50
AC
14917@item @code{x} --- reserved
14918
14919Reserved for future use.
14920
14921@item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
14922@cindex @code{X} packet
14923
14924@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
14925is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
8e04817f 14926escaped using @code{0x7d}.
c906108c 14927
ee2d5c50
AC
14928Reply:
14929@table @samp
14930@item OK
14931for success
14932@item E@var{NN}
14933for an error
14934@end table
14935
14936@item @code{y} --- reserved
c906108c 14937
ee2d5c50 14938Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14939
ee2d5c50
AC
14940@item @code{Y} reserved
14941
14942Reserved for future use.
14943
2f870471
AC
14944@item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14945@itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14946@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
ee2d5c50 14947@cindex @code{z} packet
2f870471 14948@cindex @code{Z} packets
ee2d5c50 14949
2f870471
AC
14950Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
14951watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
14952@var{length} bytes.
ee2d5c50 14953
2f870471
AC
14954Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
14955separately.
14956
512217c7
AC
14957@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
14958for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
14959remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
2f870471
AC
14960@code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
14961avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
14962be implemented in an idempotent way.}
14963
14964@item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14965@item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14966@cindex @code{z0} packet
14967@cindex @code{Z0} packet
14968
14969Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
14970@code{addr} of size @code{length}.
14971
14972A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
14973@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
14974@code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
14975breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
14976@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
c906108c 14977
2f870471
AC
14978@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
14979code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
14980overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
14981target, is not defined.}
c906108c 14982
ee2d5c50
AC
14983Reply:
14984@table @samp
2f870471
AC
14985@item OK
14986success
14987@item
14988not supported
ee2d5c50
AC
14989@item E@var{NN}
14990for an error
2f870471
AC
14991@end table
14992
14993@item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14994@item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14995@cindex @code{z1} packet
14996@cindex @code{Z1} packet
14997
14998Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
14999address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15000
15001A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
15002dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
15003
15004@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
15005movement.}
15006
15007Reply:
15008@table @samp
ee2d5c50 15009@item OK
2f870471
AC
15010success
15011@item
15012not supported
15013@item E@var{NN}
15014for an error
15015@end table
15016
15017@item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15018@item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15019@cindex @code{z2} packet
15020@cindex @code{Z2} packet
15021
15022Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
15023
15024Reply:
15025@table @samp
15026@item OK
15027success
15028@item
15029not supported
15030@item E@var{NN}
15031for an error
15032@end table
15033
15034@item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15035@item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15036@cindex @code{z3} packet
15037@cindex @code{Z3} packet
15038
2e834e49 15039Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
2f870471
AC
15040
15041Reply:
15042@table @samp
15043@item OK
15044success
15045@item
15046not supported
15047@item E@var{NN}
15048for an error
15049@end table
15050
2e834e49
HPN
15051@item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15052@item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
2f870471
AC
15053@cindex @code{z4} packet
15054@cindex @code{Z4} packet
15055
15056Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
15057
15058Reply:
15059@table @samp
15060@item OK
15061success
15062@item
15063not supported
15064@item E@var{NN}
15065for an error
ee2d5c50
AC
15066@end table
15067
15068@end table
c906108c 15069
ee2d5c50
AC
15070@node Stop Reply Packets
15071@section Stop Reply Packets
15072@cindex stop reply packets
c906108c 15073
8e04817f
AC
15074The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
15075receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
15076@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
15077when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
15078number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
15079conventions is used.
c906108c 15080
ee2d5c50 15081@table @samp
c906108c 15082
ee2d5c50
AC
15083@item S@var{AA}
15084@var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 15085
8e04817f 15086@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
ee2d5c50
AC
15087@cindex @code{T} packet reply
15088
8e04817f
AC
15089@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
15090(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
15091by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
3c3bea1c
GS
15092thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
15093@samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
15094integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
15095@value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
15096to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
c906108c 15097
ee2d5c50
AC
15098@item W@var{AA}
15099
8e04817f 15100The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
ee2d5c50
AC
15101applicable to certain targets.
15102
15103@item X@var{AA}
c906108c 15104
8e04817f 15105The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 15106
ee2d5c50
AC
15107@item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
15108
15109@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
15110@code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
15111base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
15112The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
15113the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
15114is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
c906108c 15115
ee2d5c50 15116@item O@var{XX@dots{}}
c906108c 15117
ee2d5c50
AC
15118@var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
15119any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
15120to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
15121
15122@end table
15123
15124@node General Query Packets
15125@section General Query Packets
c906108c 15126
8e04817f 15127The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 15128
ee2d5c50 15129@table @r
c906108c 15130
ee2d5c50
AC
15131@item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
15132
15133Return the current thread id.
15134
15135Reply:
15136@table @samp
15137@item @code{QC}@var{pid}
8e04817f 15138Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
ee2d5c50
AC
15139@item *
15140Any other reply implies the old pid.
15141@end table
15142
15143@item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
15144
15145@code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
c906108c 15146
8e04817f
AC
15147Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
15148may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
15149works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
15150obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
15151be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
15152sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
ee2d5c50
AC
15153
15154NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
15155
15156Reply:
15157@table @samp
15158@item @code{m}@var{id}
15159A single thread id
15160@item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
15161a comma-separated list of thread ids
15162@item @code{l}
15163(lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
15164@end table
15165
15166In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
15167more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
15168will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
8e04817f
AC
15169@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
15170(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 15171
ee2d5c50
AC
15172@item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
15173
15174Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
15175string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
15176string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
15177@value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
15178in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
15179possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
15180Mutex''.
15181
15182Reply:
15183@table @samp
15184@item @var{XX@dots{}}
15185Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
15186the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
8e04817f 15187attributes.
ee2d5c50
AC
15188@end table
15189
15190@item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
c906108c 15191
8e04817f
AC
15192Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
15193digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
15194subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
15195number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
15196(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
15197returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
ee2d5c50
AC
15198
15199NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
15200(see above).
15201
15202Reply:
15203@table @samp
15204@item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
15205Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
15206returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
15207and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
ee2d5c50
AC
15208digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
15209is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
8e04817f 15210digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
ee2d5c50 15211@end table
c906108c 15212
ee2d5c50
AC
15213@item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
15214
15215Reply:
15216@table @samp
15217@item @code{E}@var{NN}
15218An error (such as memory fault)
15219@item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
15220A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
15221@end table
15222
15223@item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
c906108c 15224
8e04817f
AC
15225Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
15226image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
15227response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
15228offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
c906108c 15229
ee2d5c50
AC
15230Reply:
15231@table @samp
15232@item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
15233@end table
15234
15235@item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
15236
8e04817f
AC
15237Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
15238encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
ee2d5c50
AC
15239
15240Reply:
15241@table @samp
15242@item *
15243@end table
15244
8e04817f 15245See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 15246
ee2d5c50
AC
15247@item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
15248
15249@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
8e04817f
AC
15250execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
15251Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
ee2d5c50
AC
15252number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
15253@emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
15254interpreter may have security implications}.
15255
15256Reply:
15257@table @samp
15258@item OK
8e04817f 15259A command response with no output.
ee2d5c50 15260@item @var{OUTPUT}
8e04817f 15261A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
ee2d5c50 15262@item @code{E}@var{NN}
8e04817f 15263Indicate a badly formed request.
ee2d5c50 15264@item @samp{}
8e04817f 15265When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
ee2d5c50
AC
15266@end table
15267
15268@item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
c906108c 15269
8e04817f
AC
15270Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
15271requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15272
15273Reply:
15274@table @samp
15275@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15276The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15277@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15278The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
15279@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
15280@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
15281@end table
15282
15283@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
15284
15285Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
15286
15287@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
15288target has previously requested.
15289
15290@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
15291@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
15292will be empty.
15293
15294Reply:
15295@table @samp
15296@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15297The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15298@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15299The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
15300encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
15301(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
15302@end table
eb12ee30 15303
ee2d5c50
AC
15304@end table
15305
15306@node Register Packet Format
15307@section Register Packet Format
eb12ee30 15308
8e04817f 15309The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
ee2d5c50
AC
15310In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
15311sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
15312to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
15313byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
15314most-significant - least-significant.
eb12ee30 15315
ee2d5c50 15316@table @r
eb12ee30 15317
8e04817f 15318@item MIPS32
ee2d5c50 15319
8e04817f
AC
15320All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1532132 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
15322registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 15323
8e04817f 15324@item MIPS64
ee2d5c50 15325
8e04817f
AC
15326All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
15327thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
15328as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 15329
ee2d5c50
AC
15330@end table
15331
15332@node Examples
15333@section Examples
eb12ee30 15334
8e04817f
AC
15335Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
15336does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 15337
474c8240 15338@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
15339-> @code{R00}
15340<- @code{+}
8e04817f 15341@emph{target restarts}
d2c6833e 15342-> @code{?}
8e04817f 15343<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15344<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15345-> @code{+}
474c8240 15346@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15347
8e04817f 15348Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 15349
474c8240 15350@smallexample
d2c6833e 15351-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
8e04817f 15352<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15353-> @code{s}
15354<- @code{+}
15355@emph{time passes}
15356<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
8e04817f 15357-> @code{+}
d2c6833e 15358-> @code{g}
8e04817f 15359<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15360<- @code{1455@dots{}}
15361-> @code{+}
474c8240 15362@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15363
aab4e0ec 15364@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 15365
6826cf00
EZ
15366@include fdl.texi
15367
6d2ebf8b 15368@node Index
c906108c
SS
15369@unnumbered Index
15370
15371@printindex cp
15372
15373@tex
15374% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15375% meantime:
15376\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15377\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15378\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15379\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15380\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15381\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15382\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15383\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15384\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15385\page\colophon
15386% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15387@end tex
15388
c906108c 15389@bye
This page took 1.759179 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.